flash/stm32l4x: STM32L55/L56xx basic support (non-secure mode)
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @end itemize
627
628 @node About Jim-Tcl
629 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
630 @cindex Jim-Tcl
631 @cindex tcl
632
633 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
634 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
635 command interpreter.
636
637 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
638 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
639 much of anything about Tcl.
640 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
641
642 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
643 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
644 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
645 OpenOCD mailing list.
646
647 @itemize @bullet
648 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
649 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
650 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
651 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
652 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
653 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
654
655 @item @b{Missing Features}
656 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
657 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
658 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
659 enabled in OpenOCD.
660
661 @item @b{Scripts}
662 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
663 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
664 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
665
666 @item @b{Commands}
667 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
668 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
669 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
670 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
671
672 @item @b{Historical Note}
673 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
674 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
675 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
676 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
677
678 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
679 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
680 @end itemize
681
682 @node Running
683 @chapter Running
684 @cindex command line options
685 @cindex logfile
686 @cindex directory search
687
688 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
689 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
690 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
691 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
692 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
693 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
694 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
695
696 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
697 tell it how each debug session should work.
698 The @option{--help} option shows:
699 @verbatim
700 bash$ openocd --help
701
702 --help | -h display this help
703 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
704 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
705 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
706 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
707 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
708 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
709 --command | -c run <command>
710 @end verbatim
711
712 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
713 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
714 To specify one or more different
715 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
716
717 @example
718 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
719 @end example
720
721 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
722 @enumerate
723 @item the current directory,
724 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
725 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
726 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
727 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
728 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
729 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
730 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
731 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
732 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
733 @end enumerate
734 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
735
736 @quotation Note
737 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
738 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
739 @end quotation
740
741 @section Simple setup, no customization
742
743 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
744 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
745 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
746 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
747 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
748
749 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
750 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
751 the server with some variation of one of the following:
752
753 @example
754 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
755 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
756 @end example
757
758 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
759 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
760 If all goes well you'll see output something like
761
762 @example
763 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
764 For bug reports, read
765 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
766 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
767 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
768 @end example
769
770 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
771 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
772 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
773
774 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
775
776 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
777 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
778 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
779 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
780 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
781 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
782 ensure that this always succeeds.
783 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
784 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
785 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
786 and then shut down without acting as a server.
787
788 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
789 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
790 those channels.
791
792 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
793 the @option{-d} option.
794
795 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
796 @option{-c} command line switch.
797
798 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
799 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
800 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
801 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
802 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
803 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
804 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
805
806 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
807 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
808
809 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
810 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
811 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
812 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
813
814 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
815 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
816
817 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
818 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
819 and start the OpenOCD server.
820 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
821 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
822 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
823 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
824
825 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
826
827 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
828 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
829 and a USB cable on the other.
830 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
831 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
832
833 @enumerate
834 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
835 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
836 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
837 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
838 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
839 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
840 debugging host.
841
842 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
843 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
844 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
845 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
846 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
847
848 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
849 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
850 with 1.2 Volt boards.
851
852 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
853 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
854 ways to connect the cable.
855 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
856 Be sure it's firmly connected.
857
858 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
859 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
860 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
861 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
862 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
863 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
864 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
865 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
866
867 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
868 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
869 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
870 but are tedious to set up.
871 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
872 adapter signals to the right board pins.
873
874 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
875 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
876 you are using to run OpenOCD.
877 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
878
879 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
880 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
881 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
882 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
883
884 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
885 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
886 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
887
888 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
889 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
890 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
891 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
892
893 @end enumerate
894
895 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
896 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
897 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
898
899 @section Project Directory
900
901 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
902
903 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
904 single directory for your work with a given board.
905 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
906 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
907 files accessed through semihosting,
908 and for code you upload to the target board.
909 It is also the natural place to write files,
910 such as log files and data you download from the board.
911
912 @section Configuration Basics
913
914 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
915 a variety of ways you can mix them.
916 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
917
918 @itemize
919 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
920 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
921 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
922 @end itemize
923
924 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
925 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
926 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
927
928 @example
929 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
930
931 # GDB can also flash my flash!
932 gdb_memory_map enable
933 gdb_flash_program enable
934
935 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
936 @end example
937
938 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
939
940 @example
941 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
942 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
943 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
944 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
945 @end example
946
947 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
948 each supporting a different development task.
949 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
950 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
951
952 @quotation Important
953 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
954 problems with how it treats variables.
955 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
956 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
957 that can be tested in a later script.
958 @end quotation
959
960 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
961 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
962 to simplify your work.
963
964 @section User Config Files
965 @cindex config file, user
966 @cindex user config file
967 @cindex config file, overview
968
969 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
970 in one place.
971 One of the following will match your situation best:
972
973 @itemize
974 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
975 provided by someone else.
976 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
977 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
978 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
979 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
980 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
981 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
982
983 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
984 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
985
986 @enumerate
987 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
988 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
989 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
990 @end enumerate
991
992 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
993 The first is an interface config file.
994 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
995 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
996 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
997 meet your deadline:
998
999 @example
1000 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1001 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1002 @end example
1003
1004 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1005 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1006 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1007 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1008
1009 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1010 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1011 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1012 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1013 target and board
1014 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1015 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1016
1017 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1018 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1019 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1020 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1021
1022 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1023 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1024 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1025 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1026 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1027
1028 @quotation Note
1029 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1030 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1031 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1032 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1033 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1034 @end quotation
1035
1036 @item
1037 You may need to write some C code.
1038 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1039 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1040 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1041 a new chip architecture.
1042 @end itemize
1043
1044 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1045 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1046 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1047
1048 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1049 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1050 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1051 @itemize
1052
1053 @item
1054 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1055 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1056 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1057 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1058
1059 @item
1060 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1061 @cindex vector_catch
1062 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1063 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1064 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1065 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1066 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1067 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1068
1069 @item
1070 You might need to override some defaults.
1071 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1072 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1073
1074 @item
1075 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1076 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1077 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1078 @end itemize
1079
1080 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1081
1082 A few project-specific utility
1083 routines may well speed up your work.
1084 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1085
1086 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1087 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1088 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1089 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1090 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1091 may help:
1092
1093 @example
1094 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1095 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1096 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1097 # Leave the CPU halted.
1098 reset init
1099
1100 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1101 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1102
1103 # Start running.
1104 resume 0x20000000
1105 @}
1106 @end example
1107
1108 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1109 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1110 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1111 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1112 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1113
1114 @example
1115 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1116 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1117 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1118 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1119 reset init
1120
1121 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1122 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1123 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1124 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1125 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1126 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1127 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1128
1129 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1130 reset run
1131 @}
1132 @end example
1133
1134 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1135 from NAND.
1136 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1137 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1138 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1139
1140 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1141 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1142
1143 @section Target Software Changes
1144
1145 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1146 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1147 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1148 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1149 handling issues like:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152
1153 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1154 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1155 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1156 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1157 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1158 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1159 your debug sessions.
1160
1161 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1162 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1163 That might however be your only option.
1164
1165 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1166 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1167 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1168 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1169 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1170 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1171 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1172 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1173 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1174 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1175 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1176 instead of the whole thing.
1177 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1178 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1179
1180 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1181 @cindex ARM semihosting
1182 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1183 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1184 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1185 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1186 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1187 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1188 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1189 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1190 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1191 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1192 NAND or SPI flash.
1193
1194 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1195 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1196 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1197 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1198 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1199
1200 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1201 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1202 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1203 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1204 registers which can be used to change various features including
1205 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1206 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1207 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1208 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1209 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1210
1211 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1212 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1213 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1214 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1215 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1216
1217 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1218 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1219 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1220 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1221 early code execution can be debugged
1222 or firmware can be replaced.
1223
1224 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1225 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1226 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1227 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1228 operations like writing to memory.)
1229
1230 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1231 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1232 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1233 various kinds of message.
1234 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1235
1236 @end itemize
1237
1238 @section Target Hardware Setup
1239
1240 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1241 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1242 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1243 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1244 working with.}
1245
1246 Common issues include:
1247
1248 @itemize @bullet
1249
1250 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1251 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1252 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1253 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1254 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1255 or one from a daughtercard).
1256 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1257 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1258
1259 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1260 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1261 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1262 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1263 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1264 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1265
1266 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1267 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1268 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1269 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1270 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1271
1272
1273 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1274 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1275 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1276 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1277 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1278 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1279 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1280
1281 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1282 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1283 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1284 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1285 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1286
1287 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1288 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1289 used to start booting.
1290
1291 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1292 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1293 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1294 multiple audio codec chips).
1295 This interacts with software
1296 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1297 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1298 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1299 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1300 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1301 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1302 audio or video codecs are used.
1303
1304 @end itemize
1305
1306 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1307 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1308 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1309 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1310 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1311 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1312 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1313 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1314 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1315 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1316
1317
1318 @node Config File Guidelines
1319 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1320
1321 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1322 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1323 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1324 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1325
1326 You should find the following directories under
1327 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1328 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1329 @itemize @bullet
1330 @item @file{interface} ...
1331 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1332 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1333 @item @file{board} ...
1334 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1335 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1336
1337 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1338 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1339 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1340 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1341 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1342 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1343 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1344 a CPU and an FPGA.
1345 @item @file{target} ...
1346 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1347 on a chip
1348 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1349 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1350 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1351 the target config file defines all of them.
1352 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1353 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1354 @end itemize
1355
1356 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1357 file may override features in any of the above files by
1358 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1359 commands specific to their situation.
1360
1361 @section Interface Config Files
1362
1363 The user config file
1364 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1365
1366 @example
1367 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1368 @end example
1369
1370 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1371 in use today with OpenOCD.
1372 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1373 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1374
1375 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1376 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1377 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1378 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1379 and need to provide a driver for it.
1380
1381 @section Board Config Files
1382 @cindex config file, board
1383 @cindex board config file
1384
1385 The user config file
1386 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1387
1388 @example
1389 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1390 @end example
1391
1392 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1393 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1394 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1395
1396 @enumerate
1397 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1398 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1399 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1400 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1401 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1402 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1403 @end enumerate
1404
1405 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1406 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1407 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1408 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1409
1410 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1411 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1412 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1413 configuration works.
1414
1415 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1416
1417 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1418 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1419 convention on how to use certain variables.
1420
1421 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1422 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1423 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1424 used at will within a target configuration file.
1425
1426 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1427 for a board with three chips:
1428
1429 @example
1430 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1431 set CHIPNAME network
1432 set ENDIAN big
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1439 set CHIPNAME video
1440 set ENDIAN little
1441 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1442 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1443 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1444 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1445
1446 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1447 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1448 unset ENDIAN
1449 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1450 @end example
1451
1452 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1453 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1454 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1455 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1456 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1457 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1458 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1459 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1460
1461 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1462 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1463 naming collisions.
1464
1465 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1466 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1467 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1468 up other clocks and peripherals.
1469
1470 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1471 @cindex variable names
1472
1473 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1474 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1475 one such chip (as shown above).
1476 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1477 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1478 to promote consistency and
1479 so that board files can override target defaults.
1480
1481 Inputs to target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1485 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1486 tap identifier dotted names.
1487 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1488 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1489 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1490 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1491 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1492 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1493 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1494 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1495 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1496 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1497 @end itemize
1498
1499 Outputs from target config files include:
1500
1501 @itemize @bullet
1502 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1503 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1504 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1505 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1506 specific to that board and that target.
1507 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1508 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1512 @cindex event, reset-init
1513 @cindex reset-init handler
1514
1515 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1516 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1517 fully set up yet.
1518 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1519 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1520 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1521 handler is one of the most important.
1522
1523 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1524 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1525 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1526 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1527 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1528
1529 @quotation Note
1530 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1531 are included here.
1532 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1533 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1534 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1535 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1536 @end quotation
1537
1538 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1539 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1540 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1541 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1542 those as parameters.
1543 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1544 and disabling the watchdog.
1545 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1546 the next developer doing such work.
1547 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1548
1549 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1550 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1551 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1552 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1553
1554 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1555
1556 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1557 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1558 a low JTAG clock rate.
1559 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1560 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1561 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1562 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1563 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1564 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1565 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1566
1567 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1568 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1569 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1570 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1571 which might be less than that.
1572
1573 @quotation Warning
1574 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1575 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1576 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1577 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1578 @end quotation
1579
1580 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1581 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1582 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1583 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1584 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1585 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1586
1587 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1588 @subsection The init_board procedure
1589 @cindex init_board procedure
1590
1591 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1592 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1593 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1594 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1595 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1596 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1597 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1598 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1599 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1600 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1601 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1602 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1603
1604 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1605 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1606
1607 @example
1608 ### board_file.cfg ###
1609
1610 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1611 source [find target/target.cfg]
1612
1613 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1614 # enables fast on-board clock source
1615 # configures the chip to use it
1616 @}
1617
1618 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1619 proc init_board @{@} @{
1620 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1621
1622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1623 adapter speed 100
1624 @}
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1627 enable_fast_clock
1628 adapter speed 10000
1629 @}
1630 @}
1631 @end example
1632
1633 @section Target Config Files
1634 @cindex config file, target
1635 @cindex target config file
1636
1637 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1638 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1639 more target config files like this:
1640
1641 @example
1642 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1643 @end example
1644
1645 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1646 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1647 In summary the target files should contain
1648
1649 @enumerate
1650 @item Set defaults
1651 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1652 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1653 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1654 @item On-Chip flash
1655 @end enumerate
1656
1657 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1658 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1659 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1660
1661 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1662 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1663 can talk to the chip.
1664 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1665 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1666 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1667 and other processing engines.
1668
1669 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1670
1671 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1672 letting board config files express environment-specific
1673 differences in how things should be set up.
1674
1675 @example
1676 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1677 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1678 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1680 @} else @{
1681 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1682 @}
1683
1684 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1685 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1686 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _ENDIAN little
1689 @}
1690
1691 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1692 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1693 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1694 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1696 @} else @{
1697 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1698 @}
1699 @end example
1700 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1701
1702 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1703 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1704 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1705
1706 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1707 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1708 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1709
1710 @example
1711 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1712 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1716 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1717 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1718 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1719 for taps.
1720
1721 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1722 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1723 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1724 looks (in part) like this:
1725
1726 @example
1727 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1728 @end example
1729
1730 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1731 to source such a config file twice, with different
1732 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1733 it adds a different TAP each time.
1734
1735 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1736 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1737 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1738 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1739
1740 @example
1741 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1743 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1744 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1745 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1746 @end example
1747
1748 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1749 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1750
1751 @itemize
1752 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1753 plus a JRC to enable them
1754 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1755 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1756 is not currently used)
1757 @end itemize
1758
1759 @subsection Add CPU targets
1760
1761 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1762 GDB and other commands can use it.
1763 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1764 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1765 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1766 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1767
1768 @example
1769 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1770 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1771 @end example
1772
1773 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1774 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1775 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1776 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1777 a work area if you can.
1778 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1779
1780 @example
1781 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1782 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1783 @end example
1784
1785 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1786 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1787 @cindex SMP
1788 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1789
1790 @example
1791 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1792 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1797 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1798 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 @end example
1800 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1801 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1802 @itemize @bullet
1803 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1804 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1805 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1806 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1807 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1808 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1809 @end itemize
1810
1811 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1812 command have been implemented.
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1815 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1816 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1817 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1818 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1819 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1820 following example.
1821 @end itemize
1822
1823 @example
1824 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1826 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1830 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1832 > resume
1833 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1834 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1835 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1836 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1840 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1841 @end example
1842
1843
1844 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1845
1846 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1847 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1848 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1849
1850 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1851 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1852 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1853 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1854 both signals.
1855
1856 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1857 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1858 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1859 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1860 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1861 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1862 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1863 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1864 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1865 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1866 not available.)
1867
1868 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1869 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1870 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1871 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1872 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1873 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1874 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1875 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1876
1877 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1878 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1879 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1880 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1881 slower clock than they will use later.
1882 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1883 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1884 than they will use later.
1885 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1886
1887 @quotation Important
1888 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1889 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1890 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1891 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1892 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1893 @end quotation
1894
1895 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1896 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1897 @cindex init_targets procedure
1898
1899 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1900 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1901 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1902 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1903 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1904 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1905 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1906 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1907 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1908
1909 @example
1910 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1911
1912 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1913 # basic initialization procedure ...
1914 @}
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1919 @}
1920
1921 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1924
1925 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1926 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1927 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1928 @}
1929 @end example
1930
1931 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1932 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1933
1934 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1935
1936 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1938
1939 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1940 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1941 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1942
1943 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1944 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1945 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1946 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1947 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1948 events already assigned.
1949
1950 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1951
1952 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1953 special high speed download features - enable it.
1954
1955 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1956
1957 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1958 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1959 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1960 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1961 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1962 If you are using an external trace port,
1963 configure it in your board config file.
1964 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1965 configure it in your target config file.
1966
1967 @example
1968 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1969 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1973
1974 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1975
1976 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1977 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1978 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1979 the TARGET (chip) file.
1980
1981 Examples:
1982 @itemize @bullet
1983 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1984 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1985 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1986 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1987 @end itemize
1988
1989 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1990 @section Translating Configuration Files
1991 @cindex translation
1992 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1993 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1994 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1995 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1996 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1997 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1998
1999 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2000 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2001 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2002 convert other scripts later on.
2003
2004 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2005 replace job:
2006
2007 @example
2008 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2009 #
2010 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2011 #
2012 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2013 #
2014 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2015
2016 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2017 global TARGETNAME
2018
2019 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2020
2021 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2022 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2023 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2024 @}
2025 @end example
2026
2027
2028
2029 @node Server Configuration
2030 @chapter Server Configuration
2031 @cindex initialization
2032 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2033 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2034 supported.
2035
2036 @anchor{configurationstage}
2037 @section Configuration Stage
2038 @cindex configuration stage
2039 @cindex config command
2040
2041 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2042 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2043 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2044 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2045 inside startup scripts.
2046
2047 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2048 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2049 which may be issued interactively.
2050 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2051 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2052
2053 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2054 flash banks,
2055 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2056 and other basic setup.
2057 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2058 may access or activate TAPs.
2059 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2060 longer be issued.
2061
2062 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2063 @section Entering the Run Stage
2064
2065 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2066 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2067 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2068 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2069 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2070 You should see no errors at this point.
2071 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2072 commands you used to configure the server.
2073 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2074 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2075 on the scan chain.
2076
2077 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2078 become available.
2079 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2080 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2081 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2082 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2083 entry to the run stage.
2084
2085 @deffn {Config Command} init
2086 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2087 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2088 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2089 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2090 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2091 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2092
2093 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2094 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2095 configuration files and/or command line options.
2096
2097 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2098 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2099 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2100 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2101 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2102 @end deffn
2103
2104 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2105 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2106 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2107
2108 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2109 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2110 scan chain.
2111 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2112 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2113
2114 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2115 they return.
2116 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2117 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2118 @end deffn
2119
2120 @anchor{tcpipports}
2121 @section TCP/IP Ports
2122 @cindex TCP port
2123 @cindex server
2124 @cindex port
2125 @cindex security
2126 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2127 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2128 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2129
2130 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2131 access using one or more of these ports.
2132 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2133 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2134 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2135
2136 @anchor{gdb_port}
2137 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2138 @cindex GDB server
2139 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2140 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2141 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2142 the normal use cases.
2143
2144 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2145 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2146 disables the gdb server.
2147
2148 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2149 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2150
2151 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2152 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2153
2154 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2155 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2156 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2157
2158 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2159 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2160 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2161 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2162 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2163 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2164 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2165 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2166 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2167
2168 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2169 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2170 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2174 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2175 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2176 output from the Tcl engine.
2177 Intended as a machine interface.
2178 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2179 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2180 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2184 Specify or query the
2185 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2186 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2187 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2188 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2189 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2193 @section GDB Configuration
2194 @cindex GDB
2195 @cindex GDB configuration
2196 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2197 The ones listed here are static and global.
2198 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2199 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2202 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2203 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2204 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2205 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2206 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2207 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2211 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2213 vFlash packet is received.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2219 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2220 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2221 for flash programming to work.
2222 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2223 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2227 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2228 by GDB memory read packets.
2229 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2230 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2234 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2235 packets report errors or not.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2237 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2238 @end deffn
2239
2240 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2241 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2242 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2243 @end deffn
2244
2245 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2246 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2247
2248 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2249 @end deffn
2250
2251 @anchor{eventpolling}
2252 @section Event Polling
2253
2254 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2255 where significant events can happen at any time.
2256 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2257 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2258 or to GDB.
2259
2260 Examples of such events include:
2261
2262 @itemize
2263 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2264 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2265 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2266 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2267 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2268 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2269 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2270 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2271 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2272 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2273 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2274 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2275 @end itemize
2276
2277 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2278 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2279 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2280 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2281 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2282
2283 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2284 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2285 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2286 to the various active targets.
2287 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2288 which is normally done in the background.
2289
2290 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2291 Poll the current target for its current state.
2292 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2293 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2294 specific information about the current state is printed.
2295 An optional parameter
2296 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2297
2298 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2299 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2300 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2301 @example
2302 > poll
2303 background polling: on
2304 target state: halted
2305 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2306 current mode: Supervisor
2307 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2308 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2309 >
2310 @end example
2311 @end deffn
2312
2313 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2314 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2315 @cindex config file, interface
2316 @cindex interface config file
2317
2318 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2319 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2320 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2321
2322 @quotation Note
2323 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2324 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2325 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2326 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2327 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2328 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2329 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2330 @end quotation
2331
2332 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2333 through commands in an interface configuration
2334 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2335 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2336
2337 @example
2338 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2339 @end example
2340
2341 These commands tell
2342 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2343 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2344
2345 @example
2346 # jlink interface
2347 adapter driver jlink
2348 @end example
2349
2350 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2351
2352
2353 @section Adapter Configuration
2354
2355 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2356 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2357 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2358
2359 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2360 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2361 target.
2362 @end deffn
2363
2364 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2365 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2366 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2367 @end deffn
2368 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2369 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2370 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2371 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2372 the hardware can support.
2373 @end deffn
2374
2375
2376
2377 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2378 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2379 @end deffn
2380
2381 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2382 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2383 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2384 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2385 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2386 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2387 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2388
2389 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @section Interface Drivers
2393
2394 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2395 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2396 available at run time.
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2399 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2400 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2401 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2402
2403 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2404 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2405 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2406 @end deffn
2407
2408 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2409 Displays status of RTCK option.
2410 Optionally sets that option first.
2411 @end deffn
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2415 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2416 This has one driver-specific command:
2417
2418 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2419 Logs some status
2420 @end deffn
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2424 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2425 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2426 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2427 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2428 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2432 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2433 or v2 (USB bulk).
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2436 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2437 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2438 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2439 @example
2440 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2441 @end example
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2445 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2446 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2450 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2451
2452 @itemize @minus
2453 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2454 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2455 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2456 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2457 @end itemize
2458 @end deffn
2459
2460 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2461 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2462 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2463 interface string or for user class interface.
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2467 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2468 @end deffn
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2472 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2476 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2480 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2481 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2482
2483 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2484 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2485
2486 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2487 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2488
2489 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2490 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2491 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2492 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2493 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2494 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2495
2496 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2497 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2498 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2499 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2500 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2501
2502 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2503 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2504 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2505 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2506
2507 @itemize @minus
2508 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2509 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2510 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2511 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2512 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2513 switching data and direction as necessary
2514 @end itemize
2515
2516 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2517 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2518
2519 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2520 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2521 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2522 @example
2523 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2524 @end example
2525 @end deffn
2526
2527 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2528 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2529 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2530 during device selection.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2534 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2535 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2536 is connected to the host.
2537 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2538 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2539 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2543 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2544 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2545
2546 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2547 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2548 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2549 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2550 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2551
2552 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2556 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2557 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2561 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2562 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2563 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2564 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2565 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2566 and initially asserted reset signals.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2570 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2571 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2572 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2573 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2574 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2575 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2576 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2577 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2578 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2579 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2580
2581 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2582 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2583 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2584 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2585 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2586 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2587
2588 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2589 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2590 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2591 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2592 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2593 are always driven by the FTDI.
2594
2595 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2596 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2597 @var{name}.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2601 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item @option{0}, drive low
2604 @item @option{1}, drive high
2605 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2606 @end itemize
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2610 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2614 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2615
2616 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2617 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2618 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2619 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2620 @itemize @minus
2621 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2622 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2623 @end itemize
2624 @end deffn
2625
2626 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2627 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2628
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2632 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2633 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2634 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2635
2636 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2637 @itemize @minus
2638 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2639 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2640 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2641 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2642 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2643 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2644 @end itemize
2645
2646 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2647 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2648 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2649 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2650 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2651 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2652 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2653 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2654
2655 FT232R
2656 @itemize @minus
2657 @item bit 7 - RI
2658 @item bit 6 - DCD
2659 @item bit 5 - DSR
2660 @item bit 4 - DTR
2661 @item bit 3 - CTS
2662 @item bit 2 - RTS
2663 @item bit 1 - RXD
2664 @item bit 0 - TXD
2665 @end itemize
2666
2667 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2668 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2671 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2672 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2676 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2677 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2678 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2682 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2683 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2687 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2691 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2695 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2699 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2703 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2707 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2711 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2712 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2713 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2714 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2715 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2716 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2717 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2718 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2719 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2720 @end deffn
2721
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2725 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2726 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2727 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2728
2729 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2730 processors which are being simulated.
2731
2732 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2733 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2734 sockets instead of TCP.
2735 @end deffn
2736
2737 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2738 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2739 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2740 @end deffn
2741
2742 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2743 something like:
2744
2745 @example
2746 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2747 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2748 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2749 @end example
2750
2751 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2752 named mysocket:
2753
2754 @example
2755 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2756 remote_bitbang_port 0
2757 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2758 @end example
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2762 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2763 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2764 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2765
2766 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2767 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2768 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2769 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2770 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2774 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2775 default values are used.
2776 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2777 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2778 @example
2779 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2780 @end example
2781 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2782 @example
2783 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2784 @end example
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2788 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2789 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2790 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2791 target board.
2792
2793 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2794 @example
2795 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2796 reset_config srst_only
2797 @end example
2798 @end deffn
2799
2800 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2801 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2802 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2803 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2804 @end deffn
2805
2806 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2807 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2808 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @end deffn
2812
2813 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2814 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2815 This has one driver-specific command:
2816
2817 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2818 Display either the address of the I/O port
2819 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2820 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2821 This is a write-once setting.
2822 @end deffn
2823 @end deffn
2824
2825 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2826 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2827 transports.
2828
2829 @quotation Compatibility Note
2830 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2831 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2832 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2833 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2834 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2835 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2836 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2837 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2838 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2839 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2840 @end quotation
2841
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2843 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2844 states.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2847 Display free device internal memory.
2848 @end deffn
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2850 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2851 command version.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2854 Display the device configuration.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2857 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2858 power state.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2861 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2864 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2865 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2866 IP configuration.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2869 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2870 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2873 Reset the current configuration.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2876 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2877 @end deffn
2878 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2879 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2880 pairs.
2881
2882 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2883 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2884 @example
2885 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2886 @end example
2887 @end deffn
2888 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2889 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2890 pairs.
2891
2892 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2893 @example
2894 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2895 77a90000
2896 @end example
2897 @end deffn
2898 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2899 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2900 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2901 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2902 the serial number instead, if possible.
2903
2904 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2905 @end deffn
2906 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2907 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2908 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2909
2910 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2911 @end deffn
2912 @end deffn
2913
2914 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2915 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2916 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2917 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2918 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2919 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2920 configuration script.
2921
2922 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2923 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2924 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2925 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2926 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2927
2928 Known limitations:
2929 @itemize @bullet
2930 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2931 and 2.7 MHz.
2932 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2933 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2934 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2935 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2936 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2937 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2938 communications with the target.
2939 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2940 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2941 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2942 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2943 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2944 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2945 @end itemize
2946
2947 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2948 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2949 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2950 @end deffn
2951
2952 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2953 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2954 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2955 @end deffn
2956
2957 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2958 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2959 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2960 target as a side-effect.
2961 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2965 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2966 version, and target voltage.
2967 @end deffn
2968 @end deffn
2969
2970 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2971 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2972 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2973 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2974 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2975
2976 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2977 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2978 This is a write-once setting.
2979 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2980
2981 @itemize @minus
2982 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2983 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2984 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2985 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2986 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2987 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2988 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2989 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2990 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2991 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2992 some versions of
2993 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2994 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2995 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2996 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2997 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2998 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2999 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3000 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3001 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3002 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3003 @end itemize
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3007 Display either the address of the I/O port
3008 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3009 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3010 This is a write-once setting.
3011
3012 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3013 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3014 you may encounter a problem.
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3018 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3019 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3020 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3021 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3022 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3023
3024 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3025 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3026 @quotation Tip
3027 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3028 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3029 @example
3030 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3031 > adapter speed 500
3032 @end example
3033 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3034 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3035 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3036 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3037 large set of samples.
3038 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3039 @example
3040 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3041 @end example
3042 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3043 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3044
3045 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3046 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3047 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3048 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3049 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3050 be conservative.
3051 @end quotation
3052 @end deffn
3053
3054 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3055 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3056 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3060 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3061
3062 @example
3063 adapter driver parport
3064 parport_port 0x278
3065 parport_cable wiggler
3066 @end example
3067 @end deffn
3068
3069 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3070 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3071 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3072 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3073 @end deffn
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3077 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3081 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3085 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3086
3087 @quotation Note
3088 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3089 which are not currently documented here.
3090 @end quotation
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @anchor{hla_interface}
3094 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3095 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3096 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3097 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3098
3099 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3100 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3101 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3102 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3103 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3104 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3105
3106 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3107 Currently Not Supported.
3108 @end deffn
3109
3110 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3111 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3112 @end deffn
3113
3114 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3115 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3119 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3123 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3124 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3125 @end deffn
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3129 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3130 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3131 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3132 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3133
3134 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3135 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3136 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3137 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3138
3139 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3140 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3141
3142 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3143 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3144 @end deffn
3145
3146 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3147 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3148 @end deffn
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3152 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3156 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3160 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3161 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3162 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3163 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3164
3165 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3166 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3167 XDS110 found will be used.
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3171 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3172 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3173 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3177 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3178 version).
3179 @end deffn
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3183 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3184 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3185 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3186 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3187
3188 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3189
3190 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3191 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3192
3193 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3194 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3195
3196 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3197
3198 @end deffn
3199 @end deffn
3200
3201 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3202 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3203 @end deffn
3204
3205 @quotation Note
3206 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3207 which are not currently documented here.
3208 @end quotation
3209
3210 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3211 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3212 No arguments: print status.
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3216 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3217 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3218
3219 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3220 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3221 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3222 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3223 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3224 configuration on exit.
3225
3226 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3227 pinout.
3228
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3232 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3233 of the one which is most popular.
3234
3235 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3236
3237 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3238 pinout.
3239
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3244 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3245 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3248 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3249 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3250
3251 @itemize @minus
3252 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3253 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3254 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3255 @end itemize
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3259 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3260 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3261 @end deffn
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3266 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3267 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3268 DPI server interface.
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3271 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3275 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3276 @end deffn
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @section Transport Configuration
3281 @cindex Transport
3282 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3283 and the debug adapter you are using,
3284 several transports may be available to
3285 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3286 @deffn Command {transport list}
3287 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3288 version of OpenOCD.
3289 @end deffn
3290
3291 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3292 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3293
3294 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3295 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3296 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3297 adapter's driver).
3298
3299 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3300 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3301 supported by the debug adapter.
3302
3303 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3304 transport, if any.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @subsection JTAG Transport
3308 @cindex JTAG
3309 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3310 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3311 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3312 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3313 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3314 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3315
3316 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3317 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3318 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3319 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3320 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3321
3322 @subsection SWD Transport
3323 @cindex SWD
3324 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3325 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3326 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3327 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3328 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3329 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3330 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3331
3332 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3333 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3334 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3335 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3336 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3337
3338 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3339 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3340 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3341 expected to change.
3342 @end deffn
3343 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3344 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3345 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3346 No parameters: displays current settings.
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @subsection SPI Transport
3350 @cindex SPI
3351 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3352 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3353 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3354 solution for flash programming.
3355
3356 @anchor{swimtransport}
3357 @subsection SWIM Transport
3358 @cindex SWIM
3359 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3360 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3361 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3362 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3363
3364 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3365
3366 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3367
3368 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3369 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3370 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3371 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3372 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3373
3374 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3375 @section JTAG Speed
3376 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3377 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3378 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3379 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3380 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3381 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3382 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3383 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3384 power management software that may be active.
3385
3386 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3387 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3388 target event handler.
3389 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3390 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3391 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3392 sets up those clocks).
3393 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3394 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3395 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3396 in the target config file.
3397 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3398 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3399 config file instead.
3400 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3401 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3402 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3403
3404 @example
3405 jtag_rclk 3000
3406 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3407 @end example
3408
3409 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3410 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3411 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3412 may not be the fastest solution.
3413
3414 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3415 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3416 which support adaptive clocking.
3417
3418 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3419 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3420 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3421 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3422 than the speed specified.
3423
3424 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3425 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3426 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3427 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3428
3429 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3430 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3431 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3432 JTAG clocking after setup.
3433 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3434 If the interface device can not
3435 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3439 @cindex adaptive clocking
3440 @cindex RTCK
3441 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3442 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3443 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3444 @example
3445 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3446 jtag_rclk 3000
3447 @end example
3448 @end defun
3449
3450 @node Reset Configuration
3451 @chapter Reset Configuration
3452 @cindex Reset Configuration
3453
3454 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3455 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3456 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3457 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3458 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3459 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3460 Please see the various board files for examples.
3461
3462 @quotation Note
3463 To maintainers and integrators:
3464 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3465 Normally the board configuration file
3466 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3467 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3468
3469 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3470 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3471 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3472 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3473 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3474 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3475 @end quotation
3476
3477 @section Types of Reset
3478
3479 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3480 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3481 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3482
3483 @itemize @bullet
3484 @item
3485 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3486 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3487 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3488 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3489 @item
3490 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3491 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3492 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3493 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3494 @item
3495 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3496 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3497 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3498 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3499 @item
3500 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3501 several other types of reset.
3502 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3503 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3504 There may be individual module resets.
3505 @end itemize
3506
3507 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3508 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3509 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3510 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3511 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3512 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3513 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3514 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3515 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3516
3517 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3518 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3519
3520 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3521 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3522 common issues are:
3523
3524 @itemize @bullet
3525
3526 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3527 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3528 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3529 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3530 when either of those signals is not connected.
3531 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3532 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3533 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3534 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3535
3536 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3537 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3538 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3539 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3540
3541 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3542 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3543 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3544 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3545 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3546 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3547 hardware debouncing.
3548 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3549 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3550
3551 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3552 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3553 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3554 to use push/pull output drivers.
3555 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3556 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3557 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3558 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3559
3560 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3561 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3562 issues (not limited to errata).
3563 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3564 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3565 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3566 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3567 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3568 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3569 @end itemize
3570
3571 There can also be other issues.
3572 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3573 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3574 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3575 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3576 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3577 Agreement (NDA).
3578
3579 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3580 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3581 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3582
3583 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3584 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3585
3586 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3587
3588 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3589 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3590 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3591 allowing it to be deasserted.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3595 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3596 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3597 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3598 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3599 @end deffn
3600
3601 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3602 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3603 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3604 allowing it to be deasserted.
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3608 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3609 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @anchor{reset_config}
3613 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3614 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3615 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3616 configuration scripts.
3617
3618 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3619 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3620 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3621 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3622 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3623 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3624 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3625 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3626
3627 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3628 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3629 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3630 -- may be specified at a time.
3631 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3632 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3633 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3634 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3635 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3636
3637 @itemize
3638 @item
3639 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3640 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3641 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3642 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3643 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3644
3645 @quotation Tip
3646 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3647 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3648 @end quotation
3649
3650 @item
3651 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3652 signal implementations.
3653 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3654 indicating everything behaves normally.
3655 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3656 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3657 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3658 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3659 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3660 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3661 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3662
3663 @item
3664 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3665 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3666 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3667 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3668 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3669 while SRST is asserted.
3670 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3671 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3675 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3676 is required to use this option.
3677 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3678 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3679 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3680 be asserted before any target connection.
3681 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3682 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3683 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3687 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3688 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3689 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3690 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3691
3692 @itemize
3693 @item
3694 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3695 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3696 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3697 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3698
3699 @item
3700 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3701 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3702 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3703 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3704 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3705 @end itemize
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @section Custom Reset Handling
3709 @cindex events
3710
3711 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3712 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3713 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3714 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3715 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3716 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3717
3718 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3719 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3720 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3721 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3722 want to reset everything at once.
3723
3724 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3725 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3726 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3727 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3728 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3729 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3730 needs special attention.
3731
3732 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3733 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3734 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3735 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3736 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3737 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3738 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3739 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3740 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3741
3742 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3743 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3744 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3745 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3746 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3747
3748 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3749 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3750 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3751 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3752 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3753 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3754 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3755 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3756 or potentially some other value.
3757
3758 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3759 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3760 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3761 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3762 (or their associated targets)
3763 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3764
3765 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3766 they return.
3767 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3768 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3772 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3773 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3774 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3775 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3776 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3777 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3778 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3779 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3780 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3781 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3782 @end deffn
3783
3784 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3785 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3786 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3787 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3788 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3789 @end deffn
3790
3791
3792 @node TAP Declaration
3793 @chapter TAP Declaration
3794 @cindex TAP declaration
3795 @cindex TAP configuration
3796
3797 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3798 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3799
3800 @itemize @bullet
3801 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3802 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3803 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3804 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3805 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3806 start running that code.
3807 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3808 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3809 and missing connections.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3813 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3814 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3815 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3816 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3817
3818 @section Scan Chains
3819 @cindex scan chain
3820
3821 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3822 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3823 They also need to be added to
3824 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3825 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3826 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3827 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3828 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3829 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3830 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3831 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3832
3833 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3834 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3835 command, presented in the next chapter.
3836 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3837 debugging targets.)
3838 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3839
3840 @verbatim
3841 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3842 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3843 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3844 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3845 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3846 @end verbatim
3847
3848 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3849 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3850 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3851 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3852 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3853 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3854 until they are told to do so.
3855
3856 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3857 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3858 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3859 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3860
3861 @example
3862 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3863 @end example
3864
3865 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3866 by a given chip.
3867 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3868 and so forth.
3869 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3870 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3871 both inside a single chip and between them.
3872 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3873
3874 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3875 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3876 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3877 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3878 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3879 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3880 includes commands something like this:
3881
3882 @example
3883 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3884 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3885 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3889 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3890 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3891
3892 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3893 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3894 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3895 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3896 @example
3897 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3898 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3899 @}
3900 @end example
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3904 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3905 and their status.
3906 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3907 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3908 but systems with a JTAG router can
3909 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3910 @end deffn
3911
3912 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3913 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3914
3915 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3916 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3917
3918 @section TAP Names
3919 @cindex dotted name
3920
3921 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3922 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3923 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3924 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3925 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3926 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3927 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3928 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3929
3930 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3931 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3932 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3933
3934 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3935
3936 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3937 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3938 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3939 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3940
3941 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3942 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3943 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3944 overridable.
3945
3946 @cindex TAP naming convention
3947 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3948 and should follow this convention:
3949
3950 @itemize @bullet
3951 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3952 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3953 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3954 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3955 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3956 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3957 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3958 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3959 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3960 with a single TAP;
3961 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3962 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3963 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3964 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3965 @end itemize
3966
3967 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3968
3969 @itemize @bullet
3970 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3971 @*The length in bits of the
3972 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3973 @end itemize
3974
3975 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3976
3977 @itemize @bullet
3978 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3979 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3980 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3981 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3982 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3983 (the TAP is linked in).
3984 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3985 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3986 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3987 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3988 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3989 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3990 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3991 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3992 values that were found but not included in the list.
3993
3994 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3995 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3996 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3997 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3998 hardware to find these values.
3999 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4000 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4001 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4002 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4003 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4004 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4005 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4006 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4007 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4008 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4009 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4010 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4011 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4012 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4013 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4014 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4015 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4016 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4017 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4018 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4019 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4020 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4021 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4022 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4023 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4024 @end itemize
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @section Other TAP commands
4028
4029 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4030 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4031 @end deffn
4032
4033 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4034 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4035 At this writing this TAP attribute
4036 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4037 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4038 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4039 See the next section for information about the available events.
4040
4041 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4042 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4043 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 @section TAP Events
4047 @cindex events
4048 @cindex TAP events
4049
4050 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4051 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4052 The other applies to debugger targets,
4053 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4054
4055 The TAP events currently defined are:
4056
4057 @itemize @bullet
4058 @item @b{post-reset}
4059 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4060 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4061 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4062 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4063 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4064
4065 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4066 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4067 of any particular target.
4068 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4069 @item @b{setup}
4070 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4071 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4072 @item @b{tap-disable}
4073 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4074 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4075 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4076 @item @b{tap-enable}
4077 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4078 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4079 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4080 @end itemize
4081
4082 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4083 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4084 contents to be accurate), you might:
4085
4086 @example
4087 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4088 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4089 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4090 @}
4091 @end example
4092
4093
4094 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4095 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4096 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4097 @cindex jrc
4098
4099 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4100 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4101 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4102 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4103 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4104
4105 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4106 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4107 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4108 be visible.
4109 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4110 ignores, such as:
4111
4112 @itemize
4113 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4114 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4115 TAPs receive new instructions.
4116 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4117 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4118 @end itemize
4119
4120 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4121 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4122 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4123 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4124
4125 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4126 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4127
4128 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4129 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4130 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4131 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4132 should define TAP event handlers using
4133 code that looks something like this:
4134
4135 @example
4136 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4137 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4138 @}
4139 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4140 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4141 @}
4142 @end example
4143
4144 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4145
4146 @example
4147 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4148 @end example
4149
4150 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4151 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4152 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4153 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4154
4155 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4156 If necessary, disables the tap
4157 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4158 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4159 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4160 and "0" if it is disabled.
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4164 If necessary, enables the tap
4165 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4166 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4167 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4168 and "0" if it is disabled.
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4172 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4173 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4174 and "0" if it is disabled.
4175
4176 @quotation Note
4177 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4178 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4179 @end quotation
4180 @end deffn
4181
4182 @anchor{autoprobing}
4183 @section Autoprobing
4184 @cindex autoprobe
4185 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4186
4187 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4188 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4189 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4190 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4191
4192 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4193 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4194 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4195 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4196 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4197 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4198 right when they come out of reset).
4199
4200 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4201
4202 @example
4203 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4204 reset_config trst_and_srst
4205 jtag_rclk 8
4206 @end example
4207
4208 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4209 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4210
4211 @enumerate
4212 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4213 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4214 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4215 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4216 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4217 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4218 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4219 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4220 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4221 that is discovered.
4222 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4223 register, it will report it.
4224 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4225 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4226 @end enumerate
4227
4228 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4229 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4230 that's a bit more complex:
4231
4232 @example
4233 clock speed 8 kHz
4234 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4235 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4236 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4237 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4238 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4239 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4240 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4241 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4242 @end example
4243
4244 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4245 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4246 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4247 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4248 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4249 and so forth.
4250
4251 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4252 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4253 @cindex DAP declaration
4254
4255 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4256 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4257 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4258 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4259 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4260
4261 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4262
4263 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4264 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4265 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4266 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4267 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4268
4269 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4270
4271 @itemize @bullet
4272 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4273 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4274 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4275 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4276 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4277 @end itemize
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn Command {dap names}
4281 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4282 for TCL scripting.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4286 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4287 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @deffn Command {dap init}
4291 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4292 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4293 initialization, too.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4297
4298 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4299 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4300 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4304 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4308 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4309 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4310 or set a new value @var{value}.
4311 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4312 @end deffn
4313
4314 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4315 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4316 @end deffn
4317
4318 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4319 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4320 value @var{value}.
4321
4322 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4323 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4324 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4325
4326 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4327 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4331 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4332 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4336 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4337 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4338 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4342 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4343
4344 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4345 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4346 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4347 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4348 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4349 for details.
4350
4351 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4352 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4353 the pattern:
4354 @example
4355 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4356 @end example
4357
4358 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4359 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4360 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4361 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4362 @example
4363 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4364 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4365 @end example
4366
4367 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4368 @example
4369 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4370 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4371 @end example
4372
4373 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4374 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4375
4376 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4377 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4378 example with a proper dap name:
4379 @example
4380 xxx.dap apcsw default
4381 @end example
4382 @end deffn
4383
4384 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4385 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4386 Disabled by default
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389
4390 @node CPU Configuration
4391 @chapter CPU Configuration
4392 @cindex GDB target
4393
4394 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4395 You can also access these targets without GDB
4396 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4397 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4398 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4399 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4400
4401 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4402 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4403
4404 @section Target List
4405 @cindex target, current
4406 @cindex target, list
4407
4408 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4409 where each member has a name.
4410 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4411 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4412 (plural!) command.
4413 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4414 look like with more than one:
4415 @verbatim
4416 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4417 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4418 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4419 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4420 @end verbatim
4421
4422 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4423 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4424 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4425 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4426 space seen by that current target.
4427 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4428 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4429 are examples; and there are many more.
4430
4431 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4432
4433 @deffn Command {target current}
4434 Returns the name of the current target.
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437 @deffn Command {target names}
4438 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4439 @example
4440 foreach t [target names] @{
4441 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4442 @}
4443 @end example
4444 @end deffn
4445
4446 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4447 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4448
4449 @deffn Command targets [name]
4450 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4451 command names are singular.}
4452
4453 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4454 targets in a user friendly form.
4455
4456 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4457 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4458 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @section Target CPU Types
4462 @cindex target type
4463 @cindex CPU type
4464
4465 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4466 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4467 when calling @command{target create}.
4468 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4469 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4470 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4471 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4472 what core-specific commands may be available
4473 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4474 and more.
4475
4476 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4477 since there's a command to list them.
4478
4479 @anchor{targettypes}
4480 @deffn Command {target types}
4481 Lists all supported target types.
4482 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4483
4484 @itemize @bullet
4485 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4486 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4487 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4488 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4489 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4490 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4491 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4492 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4493 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4494 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4495 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4496 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4497 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4498 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4499 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4500 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4501 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4502 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4503 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4504 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4505 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4506 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4507 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4508 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4509 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4510 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4511 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4512 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4513 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4514 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4515 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4516 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4517 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4518 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4519 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4520 @itemize @minus
4521 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4522 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4523 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4524 @end itemize
4525 And two debug interfaces cores:
4526 @itemize @minus
4527 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4528 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4529 @end itemize
4530 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4531 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4532 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4533 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4534 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4535 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4536 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4537 @end itemize
4538 @end deffn
4539
4540 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4541 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4542 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4543 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4544 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4545 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4546 reflect design generations;
4547 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4548 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4549
4550 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4551 @section Target Configuration
4552
4553 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4554 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4555 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4556 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4557 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4558
4559 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4560 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4561 optional parts.
4562 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4563 command, created as part of target creation.
4564
4565 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4566 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4567 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4568 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4569 to be much more board-specific.
4570 The key steps you use might look something like this
4571
4572 @example
4573 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4574 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4575 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4576 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4577 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4578 @end example
4579
4580 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4581 on-chip SRAM.
4582 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4583 writes to target memory;
4584 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4585 GDB memory checksumming;
4586 and more.
4587
4588 @quotation Warning
4589 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4590 inaccessible when application code
4591 (such as an operating system)
4592 enables or disables the MMU.
4593 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4594 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4595 easy access to other addresses needed.
4596 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4597 @end quotation
4598
4599 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4600 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4601 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4602 controllers.
4603 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4604 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4605 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4606
4607 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4608 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4609 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4610 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4611 purposes including additional configuration.
4612
4613 @itemize @bullet
4614 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4615 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4616 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4617 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4618
4619 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4620 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4621 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4622 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4623 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4624 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4625 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4626
4627 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4628 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4629 @end itemize
4630 @end deffn
4631
4632 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4633 The options accepted by this command may also be
4634 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4635 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4636 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4637
4638 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4639 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4640 and changing its endianness.
4641
4642 @itemize @bullet
4643
4644 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4645 used to access this target.
4646
4647 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4648 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4649 create and manage DAP instances.
4650
4651 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4652 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4653
4654 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4655 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4656 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4657 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4658 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4659 same event name assigns only one handler.
4660
4661 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4662 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4663
4664 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4665 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4666 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4667 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4668 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4669 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4670 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4671
4672 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4673 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4674 or virtual address is being used.
4675
4676 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4677 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4678
4679 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4680 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4681 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4682 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4683 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4684
4685 @anchor{rtostype}
4686 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4687 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4688 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4689 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4690 @option{RIOT}
4691 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4692
4693 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4694 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4695 access the target for debugging.
4696
4697 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4698 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4699 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4700 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4701
4702 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4703 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4704 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4705 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4706 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4707
4708 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4709 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4710 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4711 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4712 command @command{gdb_port}.
4713 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4714
4715 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4716 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4717 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4718 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4719 @end itemize
4720 @end deffn
4721
4722 @section Other $target_name Commands
4723 @cindex object command
4724
4725 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4726 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4727
4728 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4729 Once a button is created a button
4730 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4731 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4732 configure it like this:
4733
4734 @example
4735 # Create
4736 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4737 # Modify
4738 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4739 # Query
4740 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4741 # Report
4742 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4743 @end example
4744
4745 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4746 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4747
4748 @example
4749 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4750 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4751 @end example
4752
4753 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4754
4755 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4756 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4757 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4758 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4759 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4760 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4761 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4762 They are not otherwise documented here.
4763 @end deffn
4764
4765 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4766 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4767 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4768 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4769 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4770 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4771 the target side uses raw memory.
4772
4773 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4774 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4775 The script orientation comes from working with data
4776 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4777 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4778 and neither store nor return those values.
4779
4780 @itemize
4781 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4782 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4783 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4784 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4785 @end itemize
4786 @end deffn
4787
4788 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4789 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4790 @command{$target_name configure}
4791 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4792 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4793 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4794 There are a few special cases:
4795
4796 @itemize @bullet
4797 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4798 event named @var{event_name}.
4799 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4800 two parameters.
4801 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4802 This is a special case because this is set using
4803 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4804 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4805 @end itemize
4806
4807 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4808 all the targets you might use something like this:
4809
4810 @example
4811 foreach name [target names] @{
4812 set y [$name cget -endian]
4813 set z [$name cget -type]
4814 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4815 $x $name $y $z]
4816 @}
4817 @end example
4818 @end deffn
4819
4820 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4821 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4822 Displays the current target state:
4823 @code{debug-running},
4824 @code{halted},
4825 @code{reset},
4826 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4827 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4828 @end deffn
4829
4830 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4831 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4832 currently associated with this target.
4833 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4834 @end deffn
4835
4836 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4837 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4838 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4839 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4840 @end deffn
4841
4842 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4843 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4844 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4845 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4846 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4847 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4848 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4849 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4850 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4851 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4852 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4853 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4854 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4855 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4856 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4857 @end deffn
4858
4859 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4860 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4861 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4862 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4863 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4864 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4865 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4866 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4867 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4868 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4869 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4870 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4871 @end deffn
4872
4873 @anchor{targetevents}
4874 @section Target Events
4875 @cindex target events
4876 @cindex events
4877 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4878 For example:
4879 @itemize @bullet
4880 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4881 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4882 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4883 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4884 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4885 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4886 to set up system clocks or
4887 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4888 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4889 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4890 @end itemize
4891
4892 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4893 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4894 @command{target create ... -event}.
4895
4896 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4897 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4898 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4899
4900 @example
4901 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4902 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4903 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4904 @}
4905 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4906 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4907 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4908 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4909 @}
4910 @end example
4911
4912 The following target events are defined:
4913
4914 @itemize @bullet
4915 @item @b{debug-halted}
4916 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4917 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4918 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4919 @item @b{early-halted}
4920 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4921 @item @b{examine-start}
4922 @* Before target examine is called.
4923 @item @b{examine-end}
4924 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4925 @item @b{examine-fail}
4926 @* After target examine fails.
4927 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4928 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4929 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4930 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4931 connect GDB to running target.
4932 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4933 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4934 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4935 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4936 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4937 is in RAM or read only memory.
4938 Default is @code{halt}
4939 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4940 @* When GDB disconnects
4941 @item @b{gdb-end}
4942 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4943 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4944 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4945 @code{reset init})
4946 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4947 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4948 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4949 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4950 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4951 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4952 @item @b{gdb-start}
4953 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4954 @item @b{halted}
4955 @* The target has halted
4956 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4957 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4958 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4959 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4960 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4961 @item @b{reset-assert}
4962 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4963 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4964 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4965 it instead of asserting SRST.
4966 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4967 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4968 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4969 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4970 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4971 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4972 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4973 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4974 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4975 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4976 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4977 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4978 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4979 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4980 released on the scan chain.
4981 @item @b{reset-end}
4982 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4983 @item @b{reset-init}
4984 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4985 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4986
4987 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4988 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4989 multiplexing, and so on.
4990 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4991 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4992 @item @b{reset-start}
4993 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4994 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4995
4996 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4997 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4998 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4999 @item @b{resume-start}
5000 @* Before any target is resumed
5001 @item @b{resume-end}
5002 @* After all targets have resumed
5003 @item @b{resumed}
5004 @* Target has resumed
5005 @item @b{step-start}
5006 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5007 @item @b{step-end}
5008 @* After single-step has completed
5009 @item @b{trace-config}
5010 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5011 @end itemize
5012
5013 @node Flash Commands
5014 @chapter Flash Commands
5015
5016 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5017 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5018 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5019 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5020 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5021 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5022 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5023 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5024 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5025
5026 Flash Steps:
5027 @enumerate
5028 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5029 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5030 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5031 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5032 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5033 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5034 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5035 @item GDB Flashing
5036 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5037 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5038 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5039 @end enumerate
5040
5041 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5042 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5043 so that it can't boot.
5044 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5045 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5046
5047 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5048 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5049 @cindex flash configuration
5050
5051 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5052 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5053 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5054 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5055 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5056 see the driver-specific documentation.
5057
5058 @itemize @bullet
5059 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5060 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5061 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5062 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5063 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5064 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5065 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5066 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5067 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5068 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5069 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5070 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5071 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5072 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5073 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5074 commands to the flash controller.
5075 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5076 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5077 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5078 for more information.
5079 @end itemize
5080 @quotation Note
5081 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5082 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5083 @end quotation
5084 @end deffn
5085
5086 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5087 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5088 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5089 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5090 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5091 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5092 @end deffn
5093
5094 @deffn Command {flash list}
5095 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5096 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5097 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5098 @end deffn
5099
5100 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5101 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5102 depends on the flash type.
5103 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5104 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5105 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5106 but most don't bother.
5107 @end deffn
5108
5109 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5110
5111 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5112 begins.
5113
5114 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5115 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5116 until the programming session is finished.
5117
5118 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5119 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5120
5121 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5122
5123 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5124 @cindex flash erasing
5125 @cindex flash reading
5126 @cindex flash writing
5127 @cindex flash programming
5128 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5129
5130 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5131 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5132 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5133 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5134 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5135
5136 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5137 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5138 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5139 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5140 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5141
5142 @quotation Note
5143 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5144 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5145 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5146 back to a flash bank.
5147 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5148 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5149 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5150 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5151 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5152 @end quotation
5153
5154 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5155 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5156 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5157 disabled first.
5158 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5159 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5160 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5161
5162 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5163 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5164 up to and including @var{last}.
5165 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5166 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5167 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5168 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5169 @end deffn
5170
5171 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5172 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5173 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5174 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5175 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5176 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5177 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5178 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5179 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5180 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5181 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5182 before erase starts.
5183 @end deffn
5184
5185 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5186 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5187 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5188 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5189 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5190 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5191 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5192 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5193 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5194 before issuing this command.
5195 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5196 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5197 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5198 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5199 @end deffn
5200 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5201
5202 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5203 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5204 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5205 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5206 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5207 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5208 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5209 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5210 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5211 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5212 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5216 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5217 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5218 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5219 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5223 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5224 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5225 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5226 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5227 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5231 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5232 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5233 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5238 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5239 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5240 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5241 to the base address for each section in the image.
5242 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5243 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5244 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5245 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5246 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5247 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5248 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5249 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5250 each image section.
5251
5252 @quotation Warning
5253 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5254 data you want to preserve.
5255 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5256 sections might be erased with no notice.
5257 @itemize
5258 @item
5259 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5260 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5261 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5262 @item
5263 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5264 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5265 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5266 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5267 @end itemize
5268 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5269 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5270 @end quotation
5271
5272 @end deffn
5273
5274 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5275 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5276 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5277 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5278 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5279 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5280 ordinary memory reads.
5281 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5282 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5283 check for successful programming.
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @section Other Flash commands
5287 @cindex flash protection
5288
5289 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5290 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5291 and display that status.
5292 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5296 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5297 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5298
5299 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5300 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5301 and possibly stale information.
5302 @end deffn
5303
5304 @anchor{flashprotect}
5305 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5306 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5307 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5308 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5309 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5310 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5311 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5312 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5313 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5314 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5315 @end deffn
5316
5317 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5318 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5319 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5320 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5321 @end deffn
5322
5323 @anchor{program}
5324 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5325 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5326 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5327 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5328 @end deffn
5329
5330 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5331 @section Flash Driver List
5332 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5333 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5334 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5335
5336 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5337 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5338 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5339
5340 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5341
5342 @itemize
5343 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5344 @end itemize
5345
5346 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5347 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5348 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5349 @example
5350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5351 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5352 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5353 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5354 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5355 @end example
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @subsection External Flash
5359
5360 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5361 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5362 @cindex CFI
5363 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5364 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5365 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5366 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5367 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5368 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5369 configure a bus and its timings), or
5370 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5371 on the flash chip.
5372 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5373 speed up operation.
5374
5375 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5376
5377 @itemize
5378 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5379 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5380 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5381 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5382 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5383 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5384 @end itemize
5385
5386 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5387 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5388
5389 @example
5390 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5391 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5392 @end example
5393
5394 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5395 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5396 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5397
5398 @example
5399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5400 @end example
5401
5402 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5403 @end deffn
5404
5405 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5406 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5407 @cindex SPI
5408 @cindex jtagspi
5409 @cindex bscan_spi
5410 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5411 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5412 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5413 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5414 accessed through JTAG.
5415
5416 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5417 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5418 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5419 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5420 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5421 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5422
5423 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5424 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5425 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5426 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5427 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5428 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5429 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5430 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5431
5432 @itemize
5433 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5434 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5435 @var{USER1} instruction.
5436 @end itemize
5437
5438 @example
5439 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5440 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5442 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5443 @end example
5444 @end deffn
5445
5446 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5447 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5448 @cindex xcf
5449 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5450 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5451 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5452 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5453 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5454
5455 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5456 command accepts additional parameters:
5457 @itemize
5458 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5459 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5460 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5461 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5462 in master mode.
5463 @end itemize
5464 @example
5465 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5466 @end example
5467 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5468 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5469 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5470 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5471 dedicated sector.
5472 @end deffn
5473
5474 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5475 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5476 button.
5477 @example
5478 xcf configure 0
5479 @end example
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 Additional driver notes:
5483 @itemize
5484 @item Only single revision supported.
5485 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5486 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5487 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5488 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5489 @end itemize
5490 @end deffn
5491
5492 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5493 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5494 @cindex SPIFI
5495 @cindex lpcspifi
5496 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5497 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5498 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5499
5500 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5501 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5502 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5503 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5504 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5505
5506 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5507 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5508 are configured by the driver.
5509
5510 @example
5511 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5512 @end example
5513
5514 @end deffn
5515
5516 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5517 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5518 @cindex SMI
5519 @cindex stmsmi
5520 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5521 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5522 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5523 SPI flash devices.
5524 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5525 flash devices can be connected.
5526
5527 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5528 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5529 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5530 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5531 the flash content.
5532
5533 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5534 to identify the memory bank.
5535 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5536 flash size, are detected automatically.
5537
5538 @example
5539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5540 @end example
5541
5542 @end deffn
5543
5544 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5545 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5546 @cindex QuadSPI
5547 @cindex OctoSPI
5548 @cindex stmqspi
5549 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5550 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5551 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5552 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5553 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5554 mode is not.
5555
5556 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5557 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5558 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5559 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5560
5561 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5562 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5563 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5564
5565 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5566 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5567 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5568 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5569 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5570 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5571
5572 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5573 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5574 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5575 should be avoided.
5576
5577 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5578 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5579 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5580 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5581 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5582 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5583
5584 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5585 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5586 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5587 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5588 persist across openocd invocations.
5589
5590 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5591 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5592 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5593 required (see 'set' command).
5594
5595 @example
5596 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5598 @end example
5599
5600 There are three specific commands
5601 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5602 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5603 chip specific write protection engaged.
5604 @end deffn
5605
5606 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5607 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5608 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5609 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5610 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5611 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5612
5613 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5614 which don't support an id command.
5615
5616 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5617 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5621 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5622 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5623 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5624 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5625
5626 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5627 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5628 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5629 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5630
5631 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5632
5633 To check basic communication settings, issue
5634 @example
5635 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5636 @end example
5637 for single flash mode or
5638 @example
5639 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05; stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5640 @end example
5641 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5642
5643 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5644 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5645 need a dummy address, e.g.
5646 @example
5647 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5648 @end example
5649 should return the status register contents.
5650
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @end deffn
5654
5655 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5656 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5657 Microcontroller platform.
5658
5659 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5660 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5661
5662 @example
5663 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5664 @end example
5665
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5669 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5670 @cindex ath79
5671 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5672 chip selects.
5673 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5674 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5675 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5676 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5677 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5678 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5679
5680 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5681 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5682 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5683 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5684 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5685 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5686 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5687 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5688 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5689 with the default CS0.
5690 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5691 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5692 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5693
5694 @example
5695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5696
5697 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5698 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5699 # banks.
5700 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5701 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5702 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5703 @end example
5704
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5708 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5709 @cindex fespi
5710
5711 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5712
5713 @example
5714 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5715 @end example
5716 @end deffn
5717
5718 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5719
5720 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5721 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5722 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5723 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5724 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5725 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5726
5727 @example
5728 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5729 @end example
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5733 @cindex ambiqmicro
5734 @cindex apollo
5735 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5736 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5737 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5738 with the target using SWD.
5739
5740 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5741 the device class of the MCU.
5742 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5743 to set up the flash banks.
5744 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5745 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5746
5747 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5748 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5749 and the second bank starts after the first.
5750
5751 @example
5752 # Flash bank 0
5753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5754 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5756 $_TARGETNAME
5757 @end example
5758
5759 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5760 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5761 are available to the user.
5762
5763 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5764
5765 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5766 Erase entire bank.
5767 @end deffn
5768 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5769 Erase device pages.
5770 @end deffn
5771 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5772 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5773 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5774 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5775 the flash.
5776 @end deffn
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @anchor{at91samd}
5780 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5781 @cindex at91samd
5782 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5783 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5784
5785 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5786
5787 The devices have one flash bank:
5788
5789 @example
5790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5791 @end example
5792
5793 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5794 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5795 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5796 processor to be halted.
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5800 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5801 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5802 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5803 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5804 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5805
5806 @example
5807 at91samd set-security enable
5808 @end example
5809 @end deffn
5810
5811 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5812 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5813 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5814 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5815 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5816 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5817 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5818 in order to disable this feature.
5819
5820 @example
5821 at91samd eeprom
5822 at91samd eeprom 1024
5823 @end example
5824 @end deffn
5825
5826 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5827 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5828 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5829 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5830 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5831 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5832
5833 @example
5834 at91samd bootloader
5835 at91samd bootloader 16384
5836 @end example
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5840 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5841 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5842 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5846 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5847 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5848 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5849 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5850 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5851 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5852 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5853
5854 @example
5855 # Read user row
5856 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5857 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5858 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5859 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5860 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5861 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5862 @end example
5863 @end deffn
5864
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @anchor{at91sam3}
5868 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5869 @cindex at91sam3
5870 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5871 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5872 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5873 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5874 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5875 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5876 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5877 chips are confirmed.}
5878
5879 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5880 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5881 the following fixed locations:
5882
5883 @example
5884 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5886 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5888 @end example
5889
5890 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5891 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5892 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5893
5894 @itemize
5895 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5896 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5897 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5898 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5899 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5900 @end itemize
5901
5902 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5903
5904 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5905 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5906 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5907 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5908 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5909 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5910 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5911
5912 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5913 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5914 @end deffn
5915
5916 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5917 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5918 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5919 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5920 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5921 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5922 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5923 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5924 @end deffn
5925
5926 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5927 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5928 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5929 @end deffn
5930 @end deffn
5931
5932 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5933 @cindex at91sam4
5934 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5935 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5936 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5937 @end deffn
5938
5939 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5940 @cindex at91sam4l
5941 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5942 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5943 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5944
5945 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5946 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5947 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5948 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5949 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5950 @end deffn
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @anchor{atsame5}
5954 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5955 @cindex atsame5
5956 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5957 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5958 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5959
5960 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5961 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5962 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5963
5964 @example
5965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5966 @end example
5967
5968 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5969 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5970 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5971 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5972 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5973 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5974
5975 @example
5976 atsame5 bootloader
5977 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5978 @end example
5979 @end deffn
5980
5981 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5982 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5983 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5984 processor to be halted.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5988 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5989 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5990 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5994 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5995 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5996 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5997 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5998 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5999 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6000 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6001
6002 @example
6003 # Read
6004 >atsame5 userpage
6005 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6006 # Write
6007 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6008 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
6009 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
6010 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6011 @end example
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @end deffn
6015
6016 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6017 @cindex atsamv
6018 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6019 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6020 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6024 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6025 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6026 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6027 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6028
6029 @example
6030 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6031 @end example
6032
6033 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6034 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6035
6036 @itemize
6037 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6038 @item @var{banks}
6039 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6040 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6041 @item @var{pages_size}
6042 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6043 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6044 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6045 @end itemize
6046
6047 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6048 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6049 will be autoconfigured.
6050 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6051
6052 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6053 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6054 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6055 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6056 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6057
6058 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6059 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6060 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6061 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6062 are not truly general purpose).
6063 @quotation Note
6064 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6065 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6066 @end quotation
6067 @end deffn
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6071 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6072 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6073 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6074 @end deffn
6075
6076 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6077 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6078 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6079 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6080
6081 @example
6082 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6083 @end example
6084
6085 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6086 each single sector one by one.
6087
6088 @example
6089 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6090 @end example
6091
6092 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6093 @end deffn
6094
6095 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6096 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6097 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6098 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6099 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6100 starts at address 0.
6101
6102 @example
6103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6104 @end example
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6108 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6109 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6110 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6111 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6112 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6113 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6114 and programming the serial flash.
6115
6116 @example
6117 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6118 @end example
6119 @end deffn
6120
6121 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6122 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6123 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6124 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6125 autoconfigures itself.
6126 @example
6127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6128 @end example
6129 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6130 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6131 this via the following command:
6132 @example
6133 efm32 debuglock num
6134 @end example
6135 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6136 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6137 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6138 supported.}
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6142 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6143 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6144 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6145 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6146 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6147
6148 @example
6149 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6150 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6151 @end example
6152
6153 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6154 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6155 @end deffn
6156
6157 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6158 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6159 is an uncommon operation.}
6160 @end deffn
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6164 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6165 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6166 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6167 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6168 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6169 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6170
6171 @example
6172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6173 @end example
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6177 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6178 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6179 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6180 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6181 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6182 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6183 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6184 characters) ignored.
6185
6186 @example
6187 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6188 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6189 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6190 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6191 @end example
6192 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6193 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6194 @end deffn
6195
6196 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6197 @cindex kinetis
6198 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6199 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6200 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6201 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6202 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6203 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6204
6205 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6206 @itemize
6207 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6208 @end itemize
6209
6210 @example
6211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6212 @end example
6213
6214 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6215 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6216 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6217 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6218 @end deffn
6219
6220 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6221 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6222 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6223 set by 'flash protect' command.
6224 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6225 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6226 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6227 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6228 with the rest of a flash image.
6229 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6233 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6234 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6238 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6239 and examine-fail event.
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6243 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6244 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6245 @end deffn
6246
6247 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6248 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6249 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6250 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6251 command completes.
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6255 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6256 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6257 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6258 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6259
6260 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6261 Program Partition command.
6262
6263 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6264 Reset the device after partition setting.
6265
6266 Show partition size:
6267 @example
6268 kinetis nvm_partition info
6269 @end example
6270
6271 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6272 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6273 @example
6274 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6275 @end example
6276
6277 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6278 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6279 @example
6280 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6281 @end example
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6285 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6286 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6287 @end deffn
6288
6289 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6290 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6291 Command disables watchdog timer.
6292 @end deffn
6293 @end deffn
6294
6295 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6296 @cindex kinetis_ke
6297 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6298 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6299 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6300 autoconfigures itself.
6301 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6302
6303 @example
6304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6305 @end example
6306
6307 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6308 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6312 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6313 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6314 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6315 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6319 Command disables watchdog timer.
6320 @end deffn
6321 @end deffn
6322
6323 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6324 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6325 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6326 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6327 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6328
6329 @quotation Note
6330 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6331 driver:
6332 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6333 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6334 @end quotation
6335
6336 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6337 which must appear in the following order:
6338
6339 @itemize
6340 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6341 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6342 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6343 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6344 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6345 LPC43x[2357])
6346 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6347 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6348 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6349 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6350 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6351 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6352 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6353 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6354 at which the core is running
6355 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6356 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6357 @quotation Note
6358 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6359 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6360 However, if you do provide it,
6361 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6362 @end quotation
6363 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6364 ROM IAP entry point.
6365 @end itemize
6366
6367 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6368
6369 @example
6370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6371 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6372 @end example
6373
6374 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6375 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6376 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6377 @end deffn
6378 @end deffn
6379
6380 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6381 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6382 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6383 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6384 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6385 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6386
6387 @example
6388 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6389 @end example
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6393 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6394 from NXP.
6395
6396 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6397 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6398 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6399 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6400 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6401 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6402 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6403 you start the PLL.
6404
6405 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6406
6407 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6408 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6409 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6410
6411 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6412 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6413 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6414 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6415 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6416 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6417 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6418
6419 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6420 @example
6421 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6422 @end example
6423
6424 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6425 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6426 @code{flash banks} command.
6427
6428 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6429 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6430 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6431 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6432 a known signature.
6433 Example:
6434 @example
6435 lpc2900 signature 0
6436 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6437 @end example
6438 @end deffn
6439
6440 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6441 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6442 saves it to a file in binary format.
6443 Example:
6444 @example
6445 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6446 @end example
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6450 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6451 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6452 command:
6453
6454 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6455 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6456 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6457 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6458
6459 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6460 Example:
6461 @example
6462 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6463 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6464 @end example
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6468 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6469 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6470 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6471 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6472 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6473 912 bytes.
6474 @quotation Attention
6475 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6476 @end quotation
6477 Example:
6478 @example
6479 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6480 @end example
6481 @end deffn
6482
6483 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6484 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6485 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6486 after the next power cycle.
6487 @quotation Attention
6488 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6489 @end quotation
6490 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6491 Example:
6492 @example
6493 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6494 flash info 0
6495 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6496 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6497 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6498 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6499 @end example
6500 @end deffn
6501
6502 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6503 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6504 effective after the next power cycle.
6505 @quotation Attention
6506 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6507 @end quotation
6508 Examples:
6509 @example
6510 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6511 @end example
6512 @end deffn
6513 @end deffn
6514
6515 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6516 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6517 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6518 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6519
6520 @example
6521 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6522 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6523 @end example
6524
6525 @itemize @bullet
6526 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6527 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6528 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6529 @end itemize
6530
6531 Example usage:
6532 @example
6533 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6534 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6535 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6536 @} else @{
6537 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6538 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6539 @}
6540 @end example
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6544 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6545 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6546 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6547 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6548 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6549
6550 @example
6551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6552 @end example
6553
6554 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6555 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6556 only the main program flash.
6557
6558 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6559 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6560 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6561 @end deffn
6562
6563 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6564 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6565 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6566 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6567
6568 To erase and program the BSL:
6569 @example
6570 msp432 bsl unlock
6571 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6572 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6573 msp432 bsl lock
6574 @end example
6575 @end deffn
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6579 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6580 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6581 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6582 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6583 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6584 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6585 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6586 also have division into regions: main and info.
6587 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6588 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6589
6590 @example
6591 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6592 @end example
6593
6594 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6595
6596 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6597 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6598 @end deffn
6599
6600 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6601 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6605 Erase all userflash including info region.
6606 @end deffn
6607
6608 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6609 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6613 Check sectors protect.
6614 @end deffn
6615
6616 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6617 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6621 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6625 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6626 @end deffn
6627
6628 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6629 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6633 Show information about flash driver.
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6639 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6640 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6641 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6642 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6643
6644 @example
6645 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6646 @end example
6647
6648 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6649
6650 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6651 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6652 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6653 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6654 code.
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6658 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6659 @end deffn
6660
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6664 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6665 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6666
6667 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6668 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6669 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6670 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6671
6672 @example
6673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6674 @end example
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6678 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6679 and integrate flash memory.
6680
6681 @example
6682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6683 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6684 @end example
6685
6686 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6687 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6688 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6689 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6690 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6691 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6692 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6693 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6694 @end deffn
6695 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6696 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6697 This will remove any Code Protection.
6698 @end deffn
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6702 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6703 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6704 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6705 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6706
6707 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6708 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6709
6710 @example
6711 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6712 @end example
6713
6714 psoc4-specific commands
6715 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6716 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6717
6718 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6719 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6720
6721 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6722 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6723 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6724
6725 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6726 @end deffn
6727
6728 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6729 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6730
6731 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6732 @end deffn
6733 @end deffn
6734
6735 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6736 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6737 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6738 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6739 apart from the base address.
6740
6741 @example
6742 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6743 @end example
6744
6745 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6746 @quotation Attention
6747 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6748 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6749 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6750 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6751 @end quotation
6752
6753 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6754
6755 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6756 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6757 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6758 @end deffn
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6762 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6763 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6764 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6765 apart from the base address.
6766
6767 @example
6768 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6769 @end example
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6773 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6774 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6775 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6776
6777 @example
6778 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6779 @end example
6780
6781 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6782
6783 @itemize
6784 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6785 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6786 @end itemize
6787
6788 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6789
6790 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6791 @quotation Attention
6792 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6793 after successful write.
6794 @end quotation
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6798 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6799 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6800 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6801
6802 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6803 @itemize @bullet
6804 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6805 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6806 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6807 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6808 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6809 row size: 512 bytes.
6810 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6811 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6812 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6813 operation will erase row automatically.
6814 @end itemize
6815
6816 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6817 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6818
6819 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6820
6821 @example
6822 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6823 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6824 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6825 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6826 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6827 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6828
6829 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6830 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6831 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6832 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6833 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6834 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6835 @end example
6836
6837 psoc6-specific commands
6838 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6839 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6840 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6841 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6842 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6843 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6847 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6848 by @command{flash banks}.
6849 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6850 @end deffn
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6854 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6855 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6856 and SWD interface.
6857 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6858 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6859
6860 @example
6861 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6862 @end example
6863
6864 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6865
6866 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6867 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6868 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6872 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6873 @end deffn
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6877 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6878 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6879 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6880 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6881
6882 @example
6883 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6884 @end example
6885
6886 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6887 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6888 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6889 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6890 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6891 disabled.
6892
6893 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6894 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6895 @quotation Warning
6896 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6897 applied to all of them.
6898 @end quotation
6899 @end deffn
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6903 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6904 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6905 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6906 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6907
6908 @example
6909 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6910 @end example
6911
6912 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6913 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6914 the flash driver.
6915
6916 @example
6917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6918 @end example
6919
6920 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6921 as per the following example.
6922 @example
6923 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6924 @end example
6925
6926 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6927
6928 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6929 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6930 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6934 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6935 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6936 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6940 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6941 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6945 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6946 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6951 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6952 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6953 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6957 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6958 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6959 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6960 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6961 @end deffn
6962 @end deffn
6963
6964 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6965 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6966 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6967 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6968 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6969
6970 @example
6971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6972 @end example
6973
6974 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6975 as per the following example.
6976 @example
6977 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6978 @end example
6979
6980 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6981 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6982 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6983 @end deffn
6984
6985 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6986 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6987 the flash driver.
6988
6989 @example
6990 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6991 @end example
6992
6993 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6994
6995 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6996 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6997 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6998 @end deffn
6999
7000 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7001 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7002 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7003 @end deffn
7004
7005 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7006 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7007 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7011 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7012 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7016 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7017 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7018 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7019 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7020 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7024 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7025 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7026 @end deffn
7027 @end deffn
7028
7029 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7030 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7031 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7032 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7033 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7034
7035 @example
7036 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7037 @end example
7038
7039 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7040 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7041 the flash driver.
7042
7043 @example
7044 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7045 @end example
7046
7047 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7048
7049 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7050 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7051 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7052 @end deffn
7053
7054 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7055 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7056 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7060 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7061 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7065 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7066 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7067 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7068 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7069
7070 Example usage:
7071 @example
7072 # read OPTSR_CUR
7073 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7074 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7075 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7076 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7077 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7078 @end example
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7082 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7083 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7084 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7085 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7086 will be touched).
7087
7088 Example usage:
7089 @example
7090 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7091 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7092 @end example
7093 @end deffn
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7097 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7098 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7099 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7100 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7101
7102 @example
7103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7104 @end example
7105
7106 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7107 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7108 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7109 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7110 second bank.
7111
7112 @example
7113 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7114 @end example
7115
7116 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7117
7118 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7119 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7120 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7124 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7125 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7129 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7130 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7131 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7132 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7133 @end deffn
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7137 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7138 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7139 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7140 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7141 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7142
7143 @example
7144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7145 @end example
7146
7147 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7148 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7149 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7150 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7151
7152 @example
7153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7154 @end example
7155
7156 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7157
7158 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7159 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7164 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7169 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7170 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7174 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7175 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7176 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7177
7178 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7179 @example
7180 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7181 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7182 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7183 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7184 @end example
7185
7186 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7187 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7191 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7192 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7193 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7194 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7195
7196 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7197 @example
7198 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7199 @end example
7200
7201 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7202 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7203 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7207 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7208 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7209 @end deffn
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7213 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7214 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7215 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7216 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7217
7218 @example
7219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7220 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7221 @end example
7222
7223 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7224 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7225 for the specified flash bank.
7226 @end deffn
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7230 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7231 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7232 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7233 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7234
7235 @example
7236 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7237 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7238 @end example
7239
7240 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7241 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7243
7244 @itemize @bullet
7245 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7246 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7247 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7248 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7249 @end itemize
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @end deffn
7253
7254 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7255 @cindex str9xpec
7256
7257 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7258 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7259 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7260 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7261
7262 Here is some background info to help
7263 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7264 the str9:
7265 @enumerate
7266 @item
7267 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7268 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7269 @item
7270 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7271 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7272 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7273 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7274 @end enumerate
7275
7276 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7277 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7278 configured for flash bank 0.
7279 @example
7280 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7281 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7282 adapter assert srst
7283 # turn off target polling
7284 poll off
7285 # disable str9 core
7286 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7287 # read option bytes
7288 str9xpec options_read 0
7289 # re-enable str9 core
7290 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7291 poll on
7292 reset halt
7293 @end example
7294 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7295 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7296 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7297 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7298
7299 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7300
7301 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7302 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7306 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7307 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7311 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7312 erase the device.
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7316 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7320 Configure str9 boot bank.
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7324 Configure str9 lvd source.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7328 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7332 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7333 @end deffn
7334
7335 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7336 Read str9 option bytes.
7337 @end deffn
7338
7339 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7340 Write str9 option bytes.
7341 @end deffn
7342
7343 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7344 unlock str9 device.
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7350 @cindex swm050
7351 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7352
7353 @example
7354 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7355 @end example
7356
7357 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7358
7359 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7360 Erases the entire flash bank.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365
7366 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7367 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7368 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7369 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7370
7371 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7372
7373 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7374 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7375 @end deffn
7376
7377 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7378 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7382 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7383 the flash clock.
7384 @end deffn
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7388 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7389 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7390 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7391 correct bank config.
7392
7393 @example
7394 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7395 @end example
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7399 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7400 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7404 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7405 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7406
7407 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7408
7409 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7410 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7414 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @section NAND Flash Commands
7420 @cindex NAND
7421
7422 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7423 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7424 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7425
7426 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7427 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7428 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7429 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7430 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7431 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7432
7433 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7434 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7435 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7436 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7437 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7438 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7439 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7440 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7441 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7442 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7443
7444 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7445 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7446 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7447 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7448 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7449 every 512 bytes of data.
7450
7451 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7452 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7453 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7454 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7455 ECC mode is used.
7456
7457 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7458 @enumerate
7459 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7460 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7461 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7462 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7463 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7464 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7465 to access that device.
7466 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7467 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7468 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7469 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7470 de-brick a board.
7471 @end enumerate
7472
7473 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7474 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7475 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7476 are only 32 bits wide.
7477 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7478 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7479 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7480 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7481
7482 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7483 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7484 @cindex NAND configuration
7485
7486 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7487 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7488 OpenOCD has initialized.
7489
7490 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7491 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7492 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7493 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7494 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7495 they were a single (larger) device.
7496 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7497 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7498
7499 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7500 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7501 configuration files, not interactively.
7502
7503 @itemize @bullet
7504 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7505 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7506 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7507 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7508 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7509 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7510 commands to the NAND controller.
7511 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7512 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7513 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7514 for more information.
7515 @end itemize
7516 @end deffn
7517
7518 @deffn Command {nand list}
7519 Prints a summary of each device declared
7520 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7521 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7522 @example
7523 > nand list
7524 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7525 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7526 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7527 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7528 >
7529 @end example
7530 @end deffn
7531
7532 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7533 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7534 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7535 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7536 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7537 it with most other NAND commands.
7538 @end deffn
7539
7540 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7541
7542 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7543 @cindex NAND reading
7544 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7545 starting at the specified offset.
7546 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7547
7548 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7549 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7550
7551 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7552 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7553 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7554
7555 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7556 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7557 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7558 method which handled that error correction.
7559
7560 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7561 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7562 @itemize @bullet
7563 @item no oob_* parameter
7564 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7565 @item @code{oob_raw}
7566 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7567 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7568 spare areas associated with each data page.
7569 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7570 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7571 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7572 @item @code{oob_only}
7573 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7574 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7575 spare areas associated with each data page.
7576 @end itemize
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7580 @cindex NAND erasing
7581 @cindex NAND programming
7582 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7583 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7584 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7585 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7586 If those parameters are not specified,
7587 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7588 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7589
7590 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7591 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7592 block marker.
7593 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7594 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7598 @cindex NAND writing
7599 @cindex NAND programming
7600 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7601 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7602 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7603 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7604
7605 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7606 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7607
7608 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7609 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7610 past the end of the device.
7611 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7612 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7613 if that's being written.)
7614
7615 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7616 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7617 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7618
7619 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7620 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7621 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7622 @itemize @bullet
7623 @item no oob_* parameter
7624 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7625 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7626 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7627 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7628 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7629 @item @code{oob_only}
7630 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7631 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7632 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7633 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7634 @item @code{oob_raw}
7635 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7636 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7637 un-altered OOB.
7638 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7639 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7640 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7641 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7642 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7643 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7644 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7645 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7646 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7647 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7648 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7649 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7650 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7651 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7652 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7653 @end itemize
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7657 @cindex NAND verification
7658 @cindex NAND programming
7659 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7660 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7661 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7662
7663 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7664 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7665
7666 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7667 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7668 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7669 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7670 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7671
7672 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7673 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7674 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7675
7676 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7677 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7678 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7679 be removed in a future release.
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @subsection Other NAND commands
7683 @cindex NAND other commands
7684
7685 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7686 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7687 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7688 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7689 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7690 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7691 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7692 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7693
7694 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7695 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7696 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7697 @end deffn
7698
7699 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7700 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7701 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7702 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7703 status for each block.
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7707 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7708 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7709
7710 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7711 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7712 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7713 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7714 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7715
7716 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7717 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7718 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7719 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7720 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7721 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7722 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7726 @subsection NAND Driver List
7727 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7728 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7729 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7730
7731 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7732 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7733 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7734 address of the ECC controller.
7735 @example
7736 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7737 @end example
7738 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7739 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7740 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7741 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7742 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7743 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7744 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7745 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7746 @end deffn
7747 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7748 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7749 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7750 @end deffn
7751
7752 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7753 properly configured for input or output.
7754 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7755 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7756 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7757 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7758 @end deffn
7759 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7760 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7761 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7762 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7763 @end deffn
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7767 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7768 chips from Texas Instruments.
7769 It takes three extra parameters:
7770 address of the NAND chip;
7771 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7772 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7773 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7774 @example
7775 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7776 @end example
7777 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7778 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7779 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7780 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7781 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7782 @end deffn
7783
7784 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7785 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7786 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7787 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7788 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7789 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7790 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7794 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7795 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7796 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7797 @end deffn
7798 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7799
7800 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7801 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7802 should work for this chip as well.
7803 @end deffn
7804
7805 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7806 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7807 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7808 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7809 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7810 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7811 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7812 @example
7813 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7814 @end example
7815 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7816 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7817 without parameter query status.
7818 @end deffn
7819 @end deffn
7820
7821 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7822 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7823 parameter: the address of the controller.
7824 @example
7825 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7826 @end example
7827 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7828 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7829 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7830 change any behavior.
7831 @end deffn
7832
7833 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7834 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7835 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7836 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7837 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7838 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7839 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7840 specialized commands.
7841 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7842 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7843 change any behavior.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @node Flash Programming
7847 @chapter Flash Programming
7848
7849 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7850 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7851 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7852
7853 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7854 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7855
7856 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7857 @enumerate
7858 @item 'init' is executed.
7859 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7860 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7861 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7862 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7863 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7864 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7865 @end enumerate
7866
7867 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7868
7869 @example
7870 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7871 # are optional parameters
7872 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7873 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7874
7875 # binary files need the flash address passing
7876 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7877 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7878 @end example
7879
7880 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7881 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7882 @cindex PLD
7883 @cindex FPGA
7884
7885 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7886 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7887 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7888 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7889 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7890 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7891 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7892
7893 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7894
7895 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7896 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7897 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7898
7899 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7900 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7901
7902 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7903 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7904 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7905 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7906 behavior.
7907 @end deffn
7908
7909 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7910 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7911 @end deffn
7912
7913 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7914 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7915 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7916 @end deffn
7917
7918 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7919
7920 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7921 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7922 that particular type of PLD.
7923
7924 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7925 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7926 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7927
7928 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7929 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7930 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7931
7932 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7933 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7934 for FPGA @var{num}.
7935 @end deffn
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938 @node General Commands
7939 @chapter General Commands
7940 @cindex commands
7941
7942 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7943 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7944 commands are documented elsewhere.
7945
7946 Intent:
7947 @itemize @bullet
7948 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7949 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7950 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7951 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7952
7953 @item @b{From the human}
7954 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7955 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7956
7957 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7958 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7959 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7960
7961 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7962 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7963 port is 5555.
7964 @end itemize
7965
7966
7967 @section Server Commands
7968
7969 @deffn {Command} exit
7970 Exits the current telnet session.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7974 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7975 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7976 Not every command provides helptext.
7977
7978 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7979 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7980 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7981 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7985 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7986 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7987 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7988 Useful in connection with script files
7989 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7990 @end deffn
7991
7992 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7993 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7994 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7995 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7996
7997 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7998 @example
7999 # redefine shutdown
8000 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8001 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8002 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8003 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8004 original_shutdown
8005 @}
8006 @end example
8007 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8008 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8009 @end deffn
8010
8011 @anchor{debuglevel}
8012 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8013 @cindex message level
8014 Display debug level.
8015 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8016 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8017 Level 0 is error messages only;
8018 level 1 adds warnings;
8019 level 2 adds informational messages;
8020 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8021 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8022 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8023 the command line along with the location of that log
8024 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8025 @xref{Running}.
8026 @end deffn
8027
8028 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8029 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8030 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8031 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8032 @example
8033 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8034 @end example
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8038 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8039 the default log output channel is stderr.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8043 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8044 @end deffn
8045
8046 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8047 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8048 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8049 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8050 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8051 @end deffn
8052
8053 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8054 @section Target State handling
8055 @cindex reset
8056 @cindex halt
8057 @cindex target initialization
8058
8059 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8060 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8061 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8062 a current target which is used to perform the
8063 various operations. The current target may be changed
8064 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8065 target which should become current.
8066
8067 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8068 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8069 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8070 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8071 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8072
8073 @emph{With no arguments}:
8074 list all available registers for the current target,
8075 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8076 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8077 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8078 are flagged as such.
8079
8080 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8081 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8082 bypassing any internal cache.
8083
8084 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8085 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8086 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8087 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8088 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8089 relevant module will flush such values.
8090
8091 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8092 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8093
8094 @example
8095 > reg
8096 ===== ARM registers
8097 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8098 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8099 (2) r2 (/32)
8100 ...
8101 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8102 >
8103 @end example
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8107 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8108 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8109 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8110 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8111 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8112 (and enter debug mode).
8113 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8114
8115 @quotation Warning
8116 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8117 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8118 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8119 power mode by gating the core clock;
8120 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8121
8122 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8123 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8124 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8125 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8126 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8127 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8128
8129 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8130 work with a JTAG debugger.
8131 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8132 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8133 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8134 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8135 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8136 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8137 @end quotation
8138
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command resume [address]
8142 Resume the target at its current code position,
8143 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8144 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8145 @end deffn
8146
8147 @deffn Command step [address]
8148 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8149 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @anchor{resetcommand}
8153 @deffn Command reset
8154 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8155 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8156 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8157 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8158 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8159 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8160
8161 The optional parameter specifies what should
8162 happen after the reset.
8163 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8164 The other options will not work on all systems.
8165 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8166
8167 @itemize @minus
8168 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8169 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8170 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8171 @end itemize
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8175 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8176 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8177 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8178 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8179 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8180 state.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8184 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8185 Set values of reset signals.
8186 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8187 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8188 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8189 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8190
8191 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8192 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8193 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8194 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8195 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8196 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8197 the signal will not be modified.
8198
8199 @quotation Note
8200 TRST is specially handled.
8201 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8202 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8203 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8204 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8205 instead of the TRST signal.
8206 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8207 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8208 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8209 with handlers for that event.
8210 @end quotation
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @section I/O Utilities
8214
8215 These commands are available when
8216 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8217 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8218 notably the ZY1000.
8219 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8220
8221 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8222
8223 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8224 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8225 the text file @file{filename}.
8226 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8227 The last string is followed by a newline.
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @deffn Command cat filename
8231 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8235 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8236 into @file{dest_filename}.
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239 @deffn Command ip
8240 @emph{No description provided.}
8241 @end deffn
8242
8243 @deffn Command ls
8244 @emph{No description provided.}
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn Command mac
8248 @emph{No description provided.}
8249 @end deffn
8250
8251 @deffn Command meminfo
8252 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8253 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8254 @end deffn
8255
8256 @deffn Command peek
8257 @emph{No description provided.}
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn Command poke
8261 @emph{No description provided.}
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @deffn Command rm filename
8265 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8266 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn Command trunc filename
8270 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8274 @section Memory access commands
8275 @cindex memory access
8276
8277 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8278 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8279 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8280 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8281
8282 @enumerate
8283 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8284 to change the current target.
8285 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8286 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8287 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8288 @end enumerate
8289
8290 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8291 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8292 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8293 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8294 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8295 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8296 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8297 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8298 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8299 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8300 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8301 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8302 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8303 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8304 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8305 @end deffn
8306
8307 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8308 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8309 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8310 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8311 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8312 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8313 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8314 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8315 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8316 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8317 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8318 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @anchor{imageaccess}
8322 @section Image loading commands
8323 @cindex image loading
8324 @cindex image dumping
8325
8326 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8327 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8328 binary file named @var{filename}.
8329 @end deffn
8330
8331 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8332 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8333 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8334 @end deffn
8335
8336 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8337 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8338 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8339 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8340 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8341 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8342 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8343 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8344 separately.
8345 @end deffn
8346
8347 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8348 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8349 The file format may optionally be specified
8350 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8351 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8352 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8353 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8354 @example
8355 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8356 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8357 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8358 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8359 $address $length
8360 @}
8361 @end example
8362 @end deffn
8363
8364 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8365 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8366 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8367 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8368 The file format may optionally be specified
8369 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8370 @end deffn
8371
8372 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8373 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8374 The file format may optionally be specified
8375 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8376 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8377 @end deffn
8378
8379 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8380 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8381 The file format may optionally be specified
8382 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8383 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8384 @end deffn
8385
8386
8387 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8388 @cindex breakpoint
8389 @cindex watchpoint
8390
8391 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8392 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8393 watchpoints.
8394 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8395
8396 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8397 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8398 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8399 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8400 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8401 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8402
8403 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8404 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8408 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8412 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8416 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8417 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8418 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8419 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8420 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8421 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8422 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8423 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426 @section Misc Commands
8427
8428 @cindex profiling
8429 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8430 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8431 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8432 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8433 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8434 limit the address range.
8435 @end deffn
8436
8437 @deffn Command {version}
8438 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8442 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8443 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8444 @end deffn
8445
8446 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8447 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8448 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8449 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8450
8451 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8452 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8453 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8454 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8455
8456 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8457 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8458 @cindex tracing
8459 @cindex ETM
8460 @cindex ETB
8461
8462 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8463 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8464 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8465
8466 @itemize
8467 @item
8468 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8469 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8470 supports such an interface.
8471 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8472 and trace port support.)
8473 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8474 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8475 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8476 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8477 in the board-specific configuration file.
8478 @item
8479 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8480 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8481 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8482 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8483 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8484 @end itemize
8485
8486 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8487
8488 @quotation Issues
8489 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8490 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8491
8492 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8493 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8494 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8495 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8496 dummy trace port driver}.
8497
8498 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8499 as well as tracing only during specific states
8500 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8501
8502 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8503 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8504 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8505 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8506 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8507
8508 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8509 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8510 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8511 this original style of JTAG access.
8512 @end quotation
8513
8514 @subsection ETM Configuration
8515 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8516
8517 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8518 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8519 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8520
8521 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8522 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8523 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8524 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8525 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8526 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8527 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8528 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8529 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8530
8531 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8532 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8533 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8534
8535 @quotation Warning
8536 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8537 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8538 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8539 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8540 @end quotation
8541
8542 @quotation Note
8543 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8544 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8545 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8546 what CPU activities are traced.
8547 @end quotation
8548 @end deffn
8549
8550 @deffn Command {etm info}
8551 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8552 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8553 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8554 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @deffn Command {etm status}
8558 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8559 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8560 Did trace data overflow?
8561 Was it triggered?
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8565 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8566 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8567 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8568 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8569
8570 @itemize
8571 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8572 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8573 The value is one of
8574 @option{none} (save nothing),
8575 @option{data} (save data),
8576 @option{address} (save addresses),
8577 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8578 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8579 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8580 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8581 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8582 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8583 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8584 trace stream without an image of the code.
8585 @end itemize
8586 @end deffn
8587
8588 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8589 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8590 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8591 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8592 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8593
8594 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8595 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8596 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8600
8601 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8602 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8603 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8604
8605 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8606 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8607 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8608 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8609 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8610 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8611 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8612
8613 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8614
8615 @itemize
8616 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8617 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8618 for instruction access within that function's body.
8619 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8620 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8621 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8622 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8623 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8624 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8625 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8626 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8627 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8628 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8629 @item @emph{... more}
8630 @end itemize
8631
8632 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8633 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8634
8635 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8636 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8637 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8638 @end deffn
8639
8640 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8641 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8645 Opens an image file.
8646 @end deffn
8647
8648 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8649 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn Command {etm start}
8653 Starts trace data collection.
8654 @end deffn
8655
8656 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8657 Stops trace data collection.
8658 @end deffn
8659
8660 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8661 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8662
8663 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8664
8665 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8666 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8667 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8668 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8669 any trace data collection.}
8670 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8671 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8672 @end deffn
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8676 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8677 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8678 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8679 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8680 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8681 @end deffn
8682 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8683 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8684 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8685 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8686 trace trigger becomes active.
8687
8688 @itemize
8689 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8690 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8691 afterwards.
8692 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8693 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8694 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8695 what caused that event to happen.
8696 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8697 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8698 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8699 how the event caused trouble.
8700 @end itemize
8701 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @end deffn
8705
8706 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8707 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8708 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8709 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8710 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8711
8712 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8713 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8714
8715 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8716 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8717 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8718 @end deffn
8719
8720 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8721 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8722 @end deffn
8723
8724 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8725 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8726 @end deffn
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8730 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8731 @cindex CTI
8732
8733 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8734 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8735 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8736 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8737 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8738 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8739
8740 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8741 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8742 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8743 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8744 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8745 including additional configuration.
8746 @end deffn
8747
8748 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8749 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8750 @end deffn
8751
8752 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8753 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8757 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8758 @end deffn
8759
8760 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8761 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8762 @end deffn
8763
8764 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8765 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8766 @end deffn
8767
8768 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8769 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8770 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8771 @end deffn
8772
8773 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8774 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8775 of the CTI.
8776 @end deffn
8777
8778 @deffn Command {cti names}
8779 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8780 useful in TCL scripting.
8781 @end deffn
8782
8783 @section Generic ARM
8784 @cindex ARM
8785
8786 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8787 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8788 commands that may be available.
8789
8790 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8791 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8792 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8793 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8794 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8795 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8799 @cindex disassemble
8800 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8801 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8802 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8803 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8804 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8805 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8806 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8807
8808 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8809 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8810 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8811 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8812 with a handful of exceptions.
8813 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8817 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8818 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8819 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8820 and using the MCR instruction.
8821 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8822 an ARM register.)
8823 @end deffn
8824
8825 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8826 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8827 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8828 and the MRC instruction.
8829 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8830 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8831 an ARM register.)
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8835 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8836 core mode if necessary.
8837 @end deffn
8838
8839 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8840 @cindex ARM semihosting
8841 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8842
8843 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8844 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8845 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8846 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8847 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8848 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8852 @cindex ARM semihosting
8853 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8854
8855 @example
8856 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8857 @end example
8858
8859 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8860 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8861 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8862 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8863 @end deffn
8864
8865 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8866 @cindex ARM semihosting
8867 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8868 status.
8869
8870 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8871 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8872 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8873 debugger.
8874 @end deffn
8875
8876 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8877 @cindex ARM semihosting
8878 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8879
8880 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8881 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8882 the value returned by the target.
8883
8884 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8885 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8886 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8887 encountering a break.
8888
8889 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8890 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8891 to the debugger.
8892 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8893 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8894 request or equivalent").
8895
8896 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8897 this option (default: disabled).
8898 @end deffn
8899
8900 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8901 @cindex ARMv4
8902 @cindex ARMv5
8903
8904 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8905 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8906 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8907 variant.
8908
8909 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8910 @cindex ARM7
8911 @cindex ARM9
8912
8913 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8914 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8915 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8916 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8917
8918 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8919 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8920 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8921 instead of breakpoints.
8922 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8923
8924 This should be
8925 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8926 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8927 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8931 @cindex DCC
8932 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8933 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8934 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8935
8936 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8937 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8938 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8942 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8943 that don't check completion of the operation.
8944 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8945
8946 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8947 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8948 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8952 @cindex ARM720T
8953
8954 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8955 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8956 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8957 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8958
8959 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8960 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8961 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8962
8963 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8964 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8965 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8966 @end deffn
8967
8968 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8969 @cindex ARM9
8970
8971 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8972 integer processors.
8973 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8974
8975 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8976 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8977 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8978 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8979
8980 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8981 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8982 @cindex vector_catch
8983 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8984 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8985 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8986 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8987 to those hardware vectors.
8988
8989 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8990 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8991 vector catch hardware to intercept
8992 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8993 @option{none} of them,
8994 or a list with one or more of the following:
8995 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8996 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8997 @end deffn
8998
8999 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9000 @cindex ARM920T
9001
9002 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9003 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9004 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9005 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9006 and ARM9 commands.
9007
9008 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9009 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9010 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9014 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9015 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9016 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9017 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9018 (Not all registers can be written.)
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
9022 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9023 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9024
9025 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
9026 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
9027 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
9028 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
9029 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
9030 or using zero if no other address is provided.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9034 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9035 @end deffn
9036
9037 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9038 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9042 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9043
9044 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9045 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9046 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9047 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9048 and ARM9 commands.
9049
9050 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9051 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9052
9053 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9054 Print information about the caches found.
9055 @end deffn
9056
9057 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9058 @cindex ARM966E
9059
9060 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9061 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9062 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9063 and ARM9 commands.
9064
9065 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9066 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9067 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9068 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9069 ARM966E-S TRM.
9070 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9071 as required for BIST support.
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @subsection XScale specific commands
9075 @cindex XScale
9076
9077 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9078
9079 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9080 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9081 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9082 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9083 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9084 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9085 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9086
9087 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9088 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9089 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9090 the mini-IC.
9091
9092 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9093 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9094 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9095 code layout in memory:
9096 @example
9097 _vectors:
9098 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9099 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9100 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9101 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9102 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9103 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9104 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9105 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9106 .org 0x100
9107 .long real_reset_vector
9108 .long real_ui_handler
9109 .long real_swi_handler
9110 .long real_pf_abort
9111 .long real_data_abort
9112 .long 0 /* unused */
9113 .long real_irq_handler
9114 .long real_fiq_handler
9115 @end example
9116
9117 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9118 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9119 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9120 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9121 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9122 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9123 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9124 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9125 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9126 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9127 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9128 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9129 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9130 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9131 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9132 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9133 software.
9134
9135 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9136 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9137 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9138 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9139
9140 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9141 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9142 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9143 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9144 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9145 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9146 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9147 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9148 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9149
9150 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9151 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9152
9153 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9154 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9158 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9159 @end deffn
9160
9161 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9162 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9166 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9167 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9168 @end deffn
9169
9170 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9171 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9172 @end deffn
9173
9174 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9175 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9176 @end deffn
9177
9178 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9179 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9180 @end deffn
9181
9182 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9183 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9184 @end deffn
9185
9186 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9187 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9188 @end deffn
9189
9190 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9191 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9192 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9193 and modifying how it is emptied.
9194 @end deffn
9195
9196 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9197 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9198 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9199 The image @var{type} may be one of
9200 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9201 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9202 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9203 @end deffn
9204
9205 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9206 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9207 @cindex vector_catch
9208 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9209 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9210
9211 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9212 @example
9213 0x01 Trap Reset
9214 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9215 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9216 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9217 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9218 0x20 reserved
9219 0x40 Trap IRQ
9220 0x80 Trap FIQ
9221 @end example
9222 @end deffn
9223
9224 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9225 @cindex vector_table
9226
9227 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9228 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9229 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9230 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9231 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9232
9233 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9234
9235 @end deffn
9236
9237 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9238 @cindex ARMv6
9239
9240 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9241 @cindex ARM11
9242
9243 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9244 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9245 which is enabled by default.
9246 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9247 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9248 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9249 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9250 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9251 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9252 @end deffn
9253
9254 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9255 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9256 which is enabled by default.
9257 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9258 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9262 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9263 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9264 they are disabled by default.
9265 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9266 @end deffn
9267
9268 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9269 @cindex vector_catch
9270 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9271 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9272 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9273
9274 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9275 for certain hardware events.
9276 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9277 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9278 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9282 @cindex ARMv7
9283 @cindex ARMv8
9284
9285 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9286 @cindex Cortex-A
9287
9288 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9289 display information about target caches
9290 @end deffn
9291
9292 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9293 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9294 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9295 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9296 Defaults to 'off'.
9297 @end deffn
9298
9299 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9300 Initialize core debug
9301 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9302 @end deffn
9303
9304 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9305 Display/set the current SMP mode
9306 @end deffn
9307
9308 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9309 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9310 @end deffn
9311
9312 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9313 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9314 @end deffn
9315
9316 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9317 configure l2x cache
9318 @end deffn
9319
9320 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9321 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9322 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9323 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9324 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9325 @end deffn
9326
9327 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9328 @cindex Cortex-R
9329
9330 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9331 Initialize core debug
9332 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9336 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9337 @end deffn
9338
9339
9340 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9341 @cindex tracing
9342 @cindex SWO
9343 @cindex SWV
9344 @cindex TPIU
9345 @cindex ITM
9346 @cindex ETM
9347
9348 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)}) @
9349 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9350 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9351
9352 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9353 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9354 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9355 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9356
9357 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9358 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9359 debugger adapter features.
9360
9361 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9362 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9363
9364 Command options:
9365 @itemize @minus
9366 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9367 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9368 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware).
9369 @item @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9370 gather trace data then:
9371
9372 @itemize @minus
9373 @item append it to a regular file or a named pipe if @var{filename} is specified.
9374 @item listen to a TCP/IP port if @var{:port} is specified, then broadcast the trace data over this port.
9375 @item if '-' is specified, OpenOCD will forward trace data to @command{tcl_trace} command.
9376 @*@b{Note:} while broadcasting to file or TCP, the forwarding to @command{tcl_trace} will remain active.
9377 @end itemize
9378
9379 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9380 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width}.
9381 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9382 coding.
9383 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9384 regular UART 8N1) coding.
9385 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9386 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9387 data is to be output via SWO.
9388 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9389 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK).
9390 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9391 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9392 rate automatically.
9393 @end itemize
9394
9395 Example usage:
9396 @enumerate
9397 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9398 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9399 enough to:
9400 @example
9401 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9402 ...
9403 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9404 ...
9405 @end example
9406 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9407 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9408 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9409 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9410 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9411 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9412 @example
9413 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9414 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9415 @end example
9416 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9417 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9418 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9419 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9420 @example
9421 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9422 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9423 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9424 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9425 @end example
9426 @end enumerate
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9430 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9431 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9435 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9439 @cindex Cortex-M
9440
9441 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9442 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9443
9444 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9445 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9446 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9447 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9448 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9449 the step command leaves with the core running.
9450
9451 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9452 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9453 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9454 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9455
9456 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9457 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9458 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9459 does.
9460
9461 Default is @option{auto}.
9462 @end deffn
9463
9464 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9465 @cindex vector_catch
9466 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9467 for certain hardware events.
9468
9469 Parameters request interception of
9470 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9471 @option{none} of them,
9472 or one or more of the following:
9473 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9474 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9475 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9476 @option{irq_err},
9477 @option{state_err},
9478 @option{chk_err}, or
9479 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9480 @option{reset}.
9481 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9482 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9483 are mapped to HardFault.
9484 UsageFault checks for
9485 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9486 must also be explicitly enabled.
9487
9488 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9489 @end deffn
9490
9491 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9492 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9493 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9494
9495 @itemize @minus
9496 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9497 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9498 @end itemize
9499
9500 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9501 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9502 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9503 to manually reset the peripherals.
9504 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9505
9506 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9507 instead.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9511 @cindex ARMv8-A
9512 @cindex aarch64
9513
9514 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9515 Display information about target caches
9516 @end deffn
9517
9518 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9519 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9520 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9521 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9522 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9523 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9527 @cindex disassemble
9528 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9529 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9533 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9534 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9535 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9536 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9537 @end deffn
9538
9539 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9540 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9541 @option{on}.
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9545 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9546 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9547 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9548 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9549 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9550 @end deffn
9551
9552 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9553
9554 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9555 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9556
9557 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9558
9559 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9560 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9561 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9562 @end deffn
9563
9564 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9565 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9566 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9567 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9568 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9572
9573 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9574 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9575 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9579
9580 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9581 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9582 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9583 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9584 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9585 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9586 can be collected.
9587
9588 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9589 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9590 tooling.
9591
9592 @quotation Issues
9593 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9594 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9595 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9596 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9597
9598 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9599 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9600 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9601 software operation on the CPU.
9602 @end quotation
9603
9604 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9605 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9606 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9607 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9611 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9612 @end deffn
9613
9614 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9615 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9616 control is disabled.
9617 @end deffn
9618
9619 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9620 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9621 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9622 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9623
9624 Supported trace formats:
9625 @itemize
9626 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9627 timing to be determined.
9628 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9629 addresses.
9630 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9631 @end itemize
9632 @end deffn
9633
9634 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9635 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9636 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9637 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9638
9639 Supported conditions:
9640 @itemize
9641 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9642 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9643 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9644 instruction matches start data and mask.
9645 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9646 instruction matches start data and mask.
9647 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9648 data and mask.
9649 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9650 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9651 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9652 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9653 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9654 @end itemize
9655 @end deffn
9656
9657 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9658 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9659 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9660 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9661
9662 Supported conditions:
9663 @itemize
9664 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9665 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9666 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9667 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9668 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9669 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9670 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9671 data and mask.
9672 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9673 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9674 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9675 @end itemize
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9679 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9680
9681 Supported triggers:
9682 @itemize
9683 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9684 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9685 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9686 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9687 collection.
9688 @end itemize
9689 @end deffn
9690
9691 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9692
9693 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9694 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9695 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9696 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9700 Display trace configuration.
9701 @end deffn
9702
9703 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9704 Display trace collection status.
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9708 Start manual trace collection.
9709 @end deffn
9710
9711 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9712 Stop manual trace collection.
9713 @end deffn
9714
9715 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9716 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9717 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9718 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9719 @option{size} options using DMA.
9720 @end deffn
9721
9722 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9723 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9724 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9725 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9726 @option{size} options using DMA.
9727 @end deffn
9728
9729 @section Intel Architecture
9730
9731 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9732 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9733 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9734 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9735 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9736 @itemize
9737 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9738 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9739 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9740 @end itemize
9741
9742 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9743 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9744 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9745
9746 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9747 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9748 @end deffn
9749
9750 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9751 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9752 @end deffn
9753
9754 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9755 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9756 @end deffn
9757
9758 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9759 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9760 @end deffn
9761
9762 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9763 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9764 @end deffn
9765
9766 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9767 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9768 @end deffn
9769
9770 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9771
9772 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9773 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9774
9775 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9776 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9777 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9778 @end deffn
9779 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9780 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9781
9782 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9783
9784 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9785 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9786 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9787 @end deffn
9788
9789 @subsection Registers commands
9790 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9791 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9792 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9793
9794 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9795
9796 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9797 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9798 and "timer" groups.
9799
9800 @emph{example:}
9801 @example
9802 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9803 @end example
9804
9805
9806 @end deffn
9807 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9808 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9809
9810 @emph{group} can be "system",
9811 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9812 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9813 @end deffn
9814
9815 @section RISC-V Architecture
9816
9817 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9818 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9819 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9820 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9821 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9822 implement version 0.11.
9823
9824 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9825
9826 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9827 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9828 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9829
9830 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9831
9832 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9833 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9834 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9835
9836 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9837 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9838 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9839 CSRs.
9840 @end deffn
9841
9842 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9843 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9844 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9845 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9846 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9847 This command must be executed before `init`.
9848 @end deffn
9849
9850 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9851 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9852 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9856 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9857 deasserted.
9858 @end deffn
9859
9860 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9861 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9862 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9866 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9867 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9868 @end deffn
9869
9870 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
9871 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
9872 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
9873 on physical memory.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
9877 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
9878 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
9879 performed on physical memory.
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
9883 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
9884 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
9885 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
9886 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
9887 race condition problem in your code.
9888
9889 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
9890 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9894 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9895 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9896 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9897 values.
9898
9899 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9900 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9901 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
9905 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
9906 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
9910 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9911 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9912 @end deffn
9913
9914 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
9915 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9916 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9917 @end deffn
9918
9919 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
9920 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9921 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9922 @end deffn
9923
9924 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9925
9926 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9927 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9928 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9929 @example
9930 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9931 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9932 @end example
9933
9934 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9935 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9936 @end deffn
9937
9938 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9939 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9940 @end deffn
9941
9942 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9943
9944 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9945 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9946
9947 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
9948 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9949 @end deffn
9950
9951 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9952 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9953 @end deffn
9954
9955 @section ARC Architecture
9956 @cindex ARC
9957
9958 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9959 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9960 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9961 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9962 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9963 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9964 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9965 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9966 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9967 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9968 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9969 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9970 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9971 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9972 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9973
9974
9975 @subsection General ARC commands
9976
9977 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9978
9979 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9980 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9981 arguments:
9982
9983 @itemize @bullet
9984
9985 @item @code{-name} name
9986 @*Name of a register.
9987
9988 @item @code{-num} number
9989 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9990
9991 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9992 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9993
9994 @end itemize
9995
9996 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9997
9998 @itemize @bullet
9999
10000 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10001 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10002 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10003 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10004 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10005 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10006
10007 @item @code{-core}
10008 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10009 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10010 spaces.
10011
10012 @item @code{-bcr}
10013 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10014 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10015 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10016 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10017 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10018
10019 @item @code{-type} type_name
10020 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10021 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10022
10023 @item @code{-g}
10024 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10025 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10026 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10027 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10028 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10029
10030 @end itemize
10031
10032 @end deffn
10033
10034 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10035 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10036 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10037 @end deffn
10038
10039 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10040 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10041 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10042 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10043 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10044 startbit endbit}.
10045 @end deffn
10046
10047 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10048 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10049 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10053 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10054 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10055 @end deffn
10056
10057 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10058
10059 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10060 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10061 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10062 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10063
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10067 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10068 registers.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10072 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10073 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10074 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10075
10076 @end deffn
10077
10078 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10079 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10080 registers.
10081 @end deffn
10082
10083 @section STM8 Architecture
10084 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10085 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10086
10087 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10088 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10089
10090 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10091 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10092 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10093 @cindex tracing
10094 @cindex libdcc
10095 @cindex DCC
10096 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10097 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10098 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10099 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10100
10101 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10102 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10103 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10104 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10105 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10106 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10107
10108 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10109 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10110 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10111 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10112 The target being debugged may
10113 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10114 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10115 each supported by a command:
10116
10117 @itemize
10118 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10119 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10120 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10121 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10122
10123 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10124 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10125 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10126
10127 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10128 and then displayed at any time.
10129 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10130
10131 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10132 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10133 @end itemize
10134
10135 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10136 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10137 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10138 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10139 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10140 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10141 does the same thing.
10142
10143 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10144 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10145 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10146 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10147 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10148
10149 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10150 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10151 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10155 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10156 in the order they triggered.
10157 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10158 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10159 history records.
10160 @end deffn
10161
10162 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10163 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10164 they have been triggered.
10165 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10166 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10167 and associates it with that identifier.
10168
10169 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10170 are not related except by this command.
10171 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10172 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10173 @end deffn
10174
10175
10176 @node JTAG Commands
10177 @chapter JTAG Commands
10178 @cindex JTAG Commands
10179 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10180 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10181 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10182 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10183 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10184
10185 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10186 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10187
10188 @itemize @bullet
10189 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10190 devices such as a CPUs.
10191 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10192 standard state machine (in parallel)
10193 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10194 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10195 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10196 while the reading previous ones.
10197 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10198 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10199 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10200 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10201 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10202 registers.
10203 @end itemize
10204
10205 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10206
10207 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10208 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10209 the order of TAP state transitions.
10210 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10211 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10212 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10213 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10214 these commands are not available.
10215
10216 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10217 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10218 that specify the entire register.
10219 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10220 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10221 The return value holds the original value of each
10222 of those fields.
10223
10224 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10225 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10226 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10227 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10228 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10229
10230 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10231 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10232
10233 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10234 in that state.
10235 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10236 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10237 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10238
10239 @quotation Warning
10240 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10241 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10242 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10243 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10244 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10245 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10246 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10247 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10248 @end quotation
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10252 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10253 This may be used for performance tuning.
10254
10255 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10256 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10257 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10258 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10259 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10260 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10261 @end deffn
10262
10263 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10264 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10265 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10266 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10267 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10268 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10269
10270 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10271 in that state.
10272 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10273 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10274 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10275
10276 @quotation Note
10277 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10278 register values, unlike data register values.
10279 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10280 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10281 @end quotation
10282 @end deffn
10283
10284 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10285 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10286 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10287 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10288 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10289 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10290 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10291 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10292 The final state must also be stable.
10293 @end deffn
10294
10295 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10296 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10297 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10298 Instructions often need some time
10299 to execute before they take effect.
10300 @end deffn
10301
10302 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10303 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10304
10305 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10306 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10307 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10308 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10309 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10310 @end deffn
10311
10312 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10313 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10314 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10315 must also be enabled.
10316 Default is enabled.
10317 @end deffn
10318
10319 @section TAP state names
10320 @cindex TAP state names
10321
10322 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10323 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10324 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10325 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10326
10327 @itemize @bullet
10328 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10329 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10330 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10331 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10332 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10333 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10334 through the data register
10335 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10336 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10337 for update or more shifting
10338 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10339 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10340 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10341 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10342 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10343 through the instruction register
10344 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10345 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10346 for update or more shifting
10347 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10348 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10349 @end itemize
10350
10351 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10352 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10353 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10354 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10355
10356 @itemize @bullet
10357 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10358 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10359 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10360 may not be as expected.
10361 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10362 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10363 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10364 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10365 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10366 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10367 @end itemize
10368
10369 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10370 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10371
10372 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10373 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10374 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10375 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10376
10377 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10378 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10379 @cindex SVF
10380
10381 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10382 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10383 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10384 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10385
10386 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10387 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10388 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10389 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10390
10391 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10392 affect their semantics.
10393
10394 Command options:
10395 @itemize @minus
10396 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10397 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10398 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10399 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10400 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10401 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10402 on the real interface;
10403 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10404 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10405 errors.
10406 @end itemize
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10410 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10411 @cindex XSVF
10412
10413 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10414 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10415 Xilinx devices.
10416 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10417 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10418
10419 @quotation Important
10420 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10421 @end quotation
10422
10423 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10424 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10425 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10426 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10427 that TAP.
10428 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10429 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10430 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10431 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10432 @end deffn
10433
10434 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10435 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10436 after building the software.
10437 You may find them useful:
10438
10439 @itemize
10440 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10441 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10442 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10443 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10444 @end itemize
10445
10446 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10447 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10448 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10449 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10450 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10451 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10452 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10453
10454
10455 @node Utility Commands
10456 @chapter Utility Commands
10457 @cindex Utility Commands
10458
10459 @section RAM testing
10460 @cindex RAM testing
10461
10462 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10463 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10464 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10465 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10466 hardware problems.
10467
10468 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10469 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10470 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10471 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10472
10473 Load the memory testing functions with
10474
10475 @example
10476 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10477 @end example
10478
10479 to get access to the following facilities:
10480
10481 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10482 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10483 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10484 @end deffn
10485
10486 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10487 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10488 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10489 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10490 @end deffn
10491
10492 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10493 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10494 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10495 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10496 @end deffn
10497
10498 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10499 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10500 @end deffn
10501
10502 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10503 @cindex Firmware recovery
10504
10505 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10506 devices recovery with JTAG.
10507
10508 For quickstart instructions run:
10509 @example
10510 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10511 @end example
10512
10513 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10514 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10515 @cindex GDB
10516 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10517 to debug remote targets.
10518 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10519
10520 @itemize
10521 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10522 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10523 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10524 as shown in this chapter.
10525 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10526 that also will probably need to be configured.
10527 @end itemize
10528
10529 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10530 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10531 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10532 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10533 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10534 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10535
10536 @section Connecting to GDB
10537 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10538 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10539 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10540 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10541 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10542
10543 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10544
10545 @enumerate
10546 @item
10547 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10548 @example
10549 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10550 @end example
10551 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10552
10553 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10554 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10555 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10556
10557 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10558 remote command above that becomes:
10559 @example
10560 tar ext :3333
10561 @end example
10562
10563 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10564 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10565 available through the command:
10566 @example
10567 target remote localhost:3333
10568 @end example
10569
10570 @item
10571 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10572 @example
10573 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10574 @end example
10575 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10576 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10577 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10578 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10579 @end enumerate
10580
10581 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10582 GDB command line.
10583
10584 @section Sample GDB session startup
10585
10586 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10587 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10588 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10589 small ARM program.
10590 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10591 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10592
10593 @example
10594 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10595 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10596 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10597 ...
10598 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10599 ...
10600 (gdb) load
10601 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10602 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10603 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10604 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10605 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10606 (gdb) continue
10607 Continuing.
10608 ...
10609 @end example
10610
10611 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10612 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10613 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10614 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10615
10616 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10617
10618 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10619 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10620 packet size and the device's memory map.
10621 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10622 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10623 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10624
10625 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10626 You may need to set those up by hand.
10627 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10628 something like:
10629
10630 @example
10631 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10632 @end example
10633
10634 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10635
10636 @example
10637 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10638 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10639 @end example
10640
10641 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10642 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10643 do not have such restrictions.
10644
10645 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10646 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10647 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10648 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10649
10650 @section Programming using GDB
10651 @cindex Programming using GDB
10652 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10653
10654 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10655 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10656 @example
10657 gdb_memory_map disable
10658 @end example
10659 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10660 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10661 working area.
10662
10663 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10664 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10665 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10666 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10667
10668 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10669 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10670
10671 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10672 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10673 @example
10674 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10675 @end example
10676
10677 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10678 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10679
10680 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10681 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10682 will be used.
10683
10684 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10685 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10686 @example
10687 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10688 @end example
10689 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10690
10691 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10692 can be used.
10693
10694 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10695 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10696 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10697
10698 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10699 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10700 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10701
10702 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10703 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10704 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10705 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10706 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10707 without any intrusion of the target process.
10708
10709 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10710 Place following command after target configuration:
10711 @example
10712 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10713 @end example
10714
10715 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10716 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10717 @example
10718 gdb_memory_map disable
10719 @end example
10720
10721 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10722 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10723 @example
10724 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10725 @end example
10726
10727 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10728 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10729
10730 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10731 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10732 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10733 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10734
10735 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10736 previously shown variables.
10737
10738 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10739 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10740 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10741 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10742 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10743
10744 @section RTOS Support
10745 @cindex RTOS Support
10746 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10747
10748 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10749 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10750
10751 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10752 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10753 GDB commands.
10754
10755 @* An example setup is below:
10756
10757 @example
10758 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10759 @end example
10760
10761 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10762
10763 Currently supported rtos's include:
10764 @itemize @bullet
10765 @item @option{eCos}
10766 @item @option{ThreadX}
10767 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10768 @item @option{linux}
10769 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10770 @item @option{embKernel}
10771 @item @option{mqx}
10772 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10773 @item @option{nuttx}
10774 @item @option{RIOT}
10775 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10776 @end itemize
10777
10778 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10779 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10780
10781 @table @code
10782 @item eCos symbols
10783 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10784 @item ThreadX symbols
10785 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10786 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10787 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10788 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10789 @tex
10790 \begingroup
10791 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10792 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10793 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10794 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10795 \par
10796 \endgroup
10797 @end tex
10798 @item linux symbols
10799 init_task.
10800 @item ChibiOS symbols
10801 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10802 @item embKernel symbols
10803 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10804 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10805 @item mqx symbols
10806 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10807 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10808 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10809 @item nuttx symbols
10810 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10811 @item RIOT symbols
10812 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10813 @end table
10814
10815 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10816 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10817
10818 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10819 along with the project:
10820
10821 @table @code
10822 @item FreeRTOS
10823 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10824 @item uC/OS-III
10825 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10826 @end table
10827
10828 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10829 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10830 @cindex SMP
10831 @cindex RTOS
10832 @cindex hwthread
10833 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10834 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10835 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10836 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10837 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10838 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10839 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10840 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10841 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10842
10843 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10844 @quotation Note
10845 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10846 @end quotation
10847
10848 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10849 @itemize @bullet
10850 @item j - smp status request
10851 @item J - smp set request
10852 @end itemize
10853
10854 OpenOCD implements :
10855 @itemize @bullet
10856 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10857 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10858 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10859 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10860 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10861 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10862 @end itemize
10863
10864 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10865 @itemize @bullet
10866 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10867 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10868 @example
10869 set $_core 1
10870 #Jc01 packet is sent
10871 print $_core
10872 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10873 @end example
10874
10875 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10876 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10877
10878 @example
10879 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10880 define toggle0
10881 maint packet Jc0
10882 continue
10883 main packet Jc-1
10884 end
10885 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10886 define toggle1
10887 maint packet Jc1
10888 continue
10889 main packet Jc-1
10890 end
10891 @end example
10892 @end itemize
10893
10894 @node Tcl Scripting API
10895 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10896 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10897 @cindex Tcl scripts
10898 @section API rules
10899
10900 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10901 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10902 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10903
10904 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10905 pair list and lists.
10906
10907 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10908 list.
10909
10910 @example
10911 > set foo(me) Duane
10912 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10913 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10914 > set foo(duck) Donald
10915 @end example
10916
10917 If one does this:
10918
10919 @example
10920 > set foo
10921 @end example
10922
10923 The result is:
10924
10925 @example
10926 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10927 @end example
10928
10929 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10930
10931 @verbatim
10932 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10933 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10934 }
10935 @end verbatim
10936
10937 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10938 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10939
10940 @section Internal low-level Commands
10941
10942 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10943 invoke directly.
10944
10945 @itemize @bullet
10946 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10947
10948 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10949 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10950
10951 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10952 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10953
10954 Return information about the flash banks
10955
10956 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10957
10958 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10959 its execution. Example:
10960
10961 @example
10962 > capture "reset init"
10963 @end example
10964
10965 @end itemize
10966
10967 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10968 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10969 called "flash_banks".
10970
10971 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10972
10973 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10974 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10975 holds one of the following values:
10976
10977 @itemize @bullet
10978 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10979 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10980 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10981 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10982 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10983 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10984 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10985 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10986 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10987 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10988 @end itemize
10989
10990 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10991
10992 @quotation Note
10993 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10994 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10995 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10996 is jim, not real tcl).
10997 @end quotation
10998
10999 @section Tcl RPC server
11000 @cindex RPC
11001
11002 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11003 commands and receive the results.
11004
11005 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11006 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11007 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11008 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11009 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11010
11011 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11012 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11013 @command{capture} command.
11014
11015 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11016
11017 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11018 @cindex RPC Notifications
11019
11020 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11021 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11022
11023 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11024 in the following format.
11025
11026 @verbatim
11027 type target_event event [event-name]
11028 type target_state state [state-name]
11029 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11030 @end verbatim
11031
11032 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11033 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11034 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11035 Defaults to off.
11036
11037 @end deffn
11038
11039 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11040 @cindex RPC trace output
11041
11042 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11043 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11044
11045 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11046
11047 @verbatim
11048 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11049 @end verbatim
11050
11051 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11052 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11053 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11054 Defaults to off.
11055
11056 See an example application here:
11057 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11058
11059 @end deffn
11060
11061 @node FAQ
11062 @chapter FAQ
11063 @cindex faq
11064 @enumerate
11065 @anchor{faqrtck}
11066 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11067 @cindex RTCK
11068 @cindex adaptive clocking
11069 @*
11070
11071 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11072 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11073 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11074 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11075
11076 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11077 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11078 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11079 @enumerate
11080 @item
11081 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11082 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11083 @item
11084 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11085 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11086 @end enumerate
11087
11088 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11089 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11090 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11091 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11092 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11093 power).
11094
11095 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11096 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11097 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11098 ARM926 scenario).
11099 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11100 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11101 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11102
11103 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11104 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11105 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11106 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11107
11108 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11109
11110 In order to make use of this,
11111 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11112 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11113
11114 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11115 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11116 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11117 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11118 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11119
11120 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11121 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11122 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11123 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11124
11125 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11126 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11127 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11128 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11129 with a CPLD.
11130 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11131 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11132 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11133 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11134 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11135 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11136
11137 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11138
11139 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11140
11141 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11142 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11143 depending on the chips on your board.
11144 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11145 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11146 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11147
11148 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11149 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11150 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11151
11152 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11153 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11154 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11155 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11156
11157 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11158 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11159 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11160 this way.
11161
11162 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11163 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11164 clock rate.
11165 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11166 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11167 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11168
11169 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11170
11171 @example
11172 # Example: 1.234MHz
11173 adapter speed 1234
11174 @end example
11175
11176
11177 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11178
11179 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11180 around Windows filenames.
11181
11182 @example
11183 > echo \a
11184
11185 > echo @{\a@}
11186 \a
11187 > echo "\a"
11188
11189 >
11190 @end example
11191
11192
11193 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11194
11195 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11196 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11197 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11198
11199 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11200 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11201 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11202
11203 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11204 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11205 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11206
11207 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11208
11209 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11210 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11211 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11212 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11213
11214 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11215 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11216 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11217
11218 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11219 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11220
11221 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11222 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11223 memory read caused data abort".
11224
11225 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11226 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11227 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11228 be done, feel free to add this here.
11229
11230 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11231 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11232 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11233 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11234 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11235 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11236 gracefully stops.
11237
11238 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11239 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11240 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11241
11242 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11243 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11244 bytes. Painful...
11245
11246
11247 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11248 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11249
11250 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11251 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11252 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11253 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11254 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11255 reset, everything else should work fine.
11256
11257 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11258 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11259 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11260 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11261
11262 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11263 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11264 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11265 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11266
11267 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11268
11269 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11270 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11271 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11272
11273 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11274 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11275
11276 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11277 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11278 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11279 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11280 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11281 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11282 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11283 clock frequency?
11284
11285 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11286 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11287 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11288 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11289 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11290
11291 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11292
11293 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11294 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11295 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11296 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11297 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11298 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11299 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11300
11301 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11302
11303 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11304 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11305 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11306 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11307
11308 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11309 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11310 particular order?
11311
11312 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11313 the same order used by the hardware.
11314
11315 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11316 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11317 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11318 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11319 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11320 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11321
11322 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11323 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11324 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11325 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11326
11327 @itemize @bullet
11328 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11329 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11330 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11331 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11332 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11333 @end itemize
11334
11335 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11336
11337 @itemize @bullet
11338 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11339 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11340 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11341 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11342 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11343 @end itemize
11344
11345
11346 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11347 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11348 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11349
11350 TODO.
11351
11352 @end enumerate
11353
11354 @node Tcl Crash Course
11355 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11356 @cindex Tcl
11357
11358 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11359 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11360 how the Tcl scripts work.
11361
11362 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11363 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11364 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11365 OpenOCD.
11366
11367 @section Tcl Rule #1
11368 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11369 @enumerate
11370 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11371 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11372 @end enumerate
11373
11374 The Tcl equal is this:
11375
11376 @enumerate
11377 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11378 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11379 @end enumerate
11380
11381 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11382 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11383
11384 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11385 There is a second pair of rules.
11386 @enumerate
11387 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11388 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11389 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11390 in Tcl.
11391 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11392 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11393 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11394 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11395 @end enumerate
11396
11397 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11398 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11399 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11400 Everything is a string}
11401
11402 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11403 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11404 difference is subtle.
11405 @enumerate
11406 @item Parse Time
11407 @item Evaluation Time
11408 @end enumerate
11409
11410 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11411 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11412 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11413
11414 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11415 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11416 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11417 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11418
11419 @itemize @bullet
11420 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11421 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11422 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11423 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11424 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11425 @example
11426 # bash example
11427 X=`date`
11428 echo "The Date is: $X"
11429 # Tcl example
11430 set X [date]
11431 puts "The Date is: $X"
11432 @end example
11433 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11434 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11435 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11436 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11437 is a string}
11438 @example
11439 set x "Dinner"
11440 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11441 @end example
11442 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11443 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11444 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11445 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11446 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11447 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11448 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11449 @end itemize
11450
11451 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11452
11453 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11454
11455 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11456
11457 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11458 the normal way.
11459
11460 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11461 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11462 line is immediately executed.
11463
11464 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11465 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11466
11467 @subsection Command Execution
11468
11469 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11470 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11471 control flow operators.
11472
11473 Commands are executed like this:
11474
11475 @enumerate
11476 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11477 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11478 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11479 @end enumerate
11480
11481 It sort of works like this:
11482 @example
11483 for(;;)@{
11484 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11485
11486 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11487
11488 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11489 @}
11490 @end example
11491
11492 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11493 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11494 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11495 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11496 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11497 ``LookupCommand()''
11498
11499 @subsection The FOR command
11500
11501 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11502 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11503 command just like any other command.
11504
11505 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11506 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11507 are:
11508
11509 @enumerate 0
11510 @item The ascii text 'for'
11511 @item The start text
11512 @item The test expression
11513 @item The next text
11514 @item The body text
11515 @end enumerate
11516
11517 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11518 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11519 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11520 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11521
11522 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11523 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11524
11525 @example
11526 int
11527 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11528 int *argc,
11529 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11530 @end example
11531
11532 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11533 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11534 still operates in the same basic way.
11535
11536 @subsection FOR command implementation
11537
11538 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11539 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11540
11541 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11542
11543 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11544
11545 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11546 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11547 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11548
11549 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11550 expression and returns a value.
11551
11552 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11553 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11554 @example
11555 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11556
11557 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11558
11559 int
11560 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11561 int argc,
11562 char **argv )
11563 @{
11564 if( argc != 5 )@{
11565 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11566 return ERROR;
11567 @}
11568
11569 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11570
11571 // Execute the start statement.
11572 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11573
11574 // Top of loop test
11575 for(;;)@{
11576 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11577 if( i == 0 )
11578 break;
11579
11580 // Execute the body
11581 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11582
11583 // Execute the LOOP part
11584 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11585 @}
11586
11587 // Return no error
11588 SetResult( interp, "" );
11589 return SUCCESS;
11590 @}
11591 @end example
11592
11593 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11594 in the same basic way.
11595
11596 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11597
11598 @subsection source and find commands
11599 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11600 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11601 @*Remember the parsing rules
11602 @enumerate
11603 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11604 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11605 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11606 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11607 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11608 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11609 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11610 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11611 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11612 @end enumerate
11613 @subsection format command
11614 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11615 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11616 @b{sprintf()}.
11617 @b{Example}
11618 @example
11619 set x 6
11620 set y 7
11621 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11622 @end example
11623 @enumerate
11624 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11625 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11626 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11627 @* Refer to Rule #1
11628 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11629 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11630 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11631 @end enumerate
11632 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11633 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11634 @example
11635 #1 Good
11636 proc someproc @{@} @{
11637 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11638 @}
11639 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11640 #2 Good - no variables
11641 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11642 #3 Good Curly Braces
11643 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11644 puts "Time: [date]"
11645 @}
11646 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11647 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11648 @end example
11649 @enumerate
11650 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11651 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11652 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11653 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11654 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11655 command.
11656 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11657 @*There are 4 examples:
11658 @enumerate
11659 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11660 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11661 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11662 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11663 @end enumerate
11664
11665 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11666 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11667 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11668
11669 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11670 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11671 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11672 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11673 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11674 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11675 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11676 @end enumerate
11677 @subsection Global Variables
11678 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11679 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11680 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11681 @example
11682 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11683 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11684 global x #Global variable X
11685 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11686 @}
11687 @end example
11688 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11689 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11690 @example
11691 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11692 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11693 # Create var name
11694 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11695 # Make it a global
11696 global $vn
11697 # Set it.
11698 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11699 @}
11700 @end example
11701 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11702 @example
11703 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11704 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11705 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11706 @}
11707 @end example
11708
11709 @include fdl.texi
11710
11711 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11712 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11713 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11714 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11715 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11716 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11717
11718 @printindex cp
11719
11720 @node Command and Driver Index
11721 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11722 @printindex fn
11723
11724 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)